blob: dd458bd88651cbf7dd264fd3818d86cc3081ee39 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau41551c62020-07-31 14:28:41 +02007 2020/07/31
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
676. HTTP header manipulation
68
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
707.1. ACL basics
717.1.1. Matching booleans
727.1.2. Matching integers
737.1.3. Matching strings
747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
787.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200797.3.1. Converters
807.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086
878. Logging
888.1. Log levels
898.2. Log formats
908.2.1. Default log format
918.2.2. TCP log format
928.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100938.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100948.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200958.3. Advanced logging options
968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1008.4. Timing events
1018.5. Session state at disconnection
1028.6. Non-printable characters
1038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1058.9. Examples of logs
106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001079. Supported filters
1089.1. Trace
1099.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001109.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001119.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200112
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011310. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011410.1. Limitation
11510.2. Setup
11610.2.1. Cache section
11710.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118
1191. Quick reminder about HTTP
120----------------------------
121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
124on almost anything found in the contents.
125
126However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
127formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
128correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
129
130
1311.1. The HTTP transaction model
132-------------------------------
133
134The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100135to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
137connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138will involve a new connection :
139
140 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
141
142In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
143establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
144by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
145length.
146
147Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
148to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
149however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
150response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
151header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
156power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
157but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100160Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
162second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
163page :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
168latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
169correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
170the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100171server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
174time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
175are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
176parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
177carry the stream identifier.
178
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100179By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
180connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
181leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
183processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
184waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200185
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200186HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
188 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100189 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200191 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194
1951.2. HTTP request
196-----------------
197
198First, let's consider this HTTP request :
199
200 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100201 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
203 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
204 3 User-agent: my small browser
205 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
206 5 Accept: image/png
207
208
2091.2.1. The Request line
210-----------------------
211
212Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
213
214 - a METHOD : GET
215 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
216 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
217
218All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
219which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
220followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
221is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
222desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
223the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
224
225The URI itself can have several forms :
226
227 - A "relative URI" :
228
229 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
230
231 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
232 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
233
234 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
235
236 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
237
238 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
239 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
240 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
241 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
242 must accept this form too.
243
244 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
245 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
246 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100247
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200248 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
249 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
250 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
251 other protocols too.
252
253In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
254mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
255on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
256It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
257specific to the language, framework or application in use.
258
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100259HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100260assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200262
2631.2.2. The request headers
264--------------------------
265
266The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
267beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
268an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
269Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
270values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
271encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
272the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
273define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
274
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200276their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau371ab182020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200278as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
279normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
280representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
281HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200282
283The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
284that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
285is one valid form of empty line.
286
287Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
288headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
289about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
290application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
291
292Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000293 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
295 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
296 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
297
298
2991.3. HTTP response
300------------------
301
302An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
303messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
304
305 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100306 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200307 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
308 2 Content-length: 350
309 3 Content-Type: text/html
310
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200311As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
312codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
313response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100314continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
315the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
316following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
317sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
318(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
319correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
320such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
321state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
322over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
323if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
324information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200325
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003271.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200328------------------------
329
330Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
331
332 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
333 - a status code : 200
334 - a reason : OK
335
336The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100337 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
338 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
339 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
340 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
341 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000343Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100344"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
346messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
347or "Authentication Required".
348
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100349HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350
351 Code When / reason
352 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
353 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
354 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
355 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100356 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
357 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358 400 for an invalid or too large request
359 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
360 accessing the stats page)
361 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
Florian Tham9f3bda02020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100362 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Thamc09f7972020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100364 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
365 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
367 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
368 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
369 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
370 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
371 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
372 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
373
374The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3754.2).
376
377
3781.3.2. The response headers
379---------------------------
380
381Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
382the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
383details.
384
385
3862. Configuring HAProxy
387----------------------
388
3892.1. Configuration file format
390------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200391
392HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
393
394 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
395 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
396 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
397 "frontend" and "backend".
398
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100399The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
400referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200401delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100402
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200403
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004042.2. Quoting and escaping
405-------------------------
406
407HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
408many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
409with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
410single quotes.
411
412If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
413them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
414escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
415
416Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
417
418 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
419 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
420 \\ to use a backslash
421 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
422 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
423
424Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
425the interpretation of:
426
427 space as a parameter separator
428 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
429 # hash as a comment start
430
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200431Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
432-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
433backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
434
435Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200436quoting.
437
438Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
439nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
440
441Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
442equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
443
444 Example:
445 # those are equivalents:
446 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
447 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
448 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
451
452 # those are equivalents:
453 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
454 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
455 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
457
458
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004592.3. Environment variables
460--------------------------
461
462HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
463interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
464configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
465optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
466shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
467underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
468
469 Example:
470
471 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
472
473 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
474
475 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
476
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200477Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
478file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200480* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
481 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
482
483* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
484 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
485 directory.
486
487* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
488
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500489* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200490 processes, separated by semicolons.
491
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500492* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493 CLI, separated by semicolons.
494
495See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200496
4972.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200498----------------
499
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100500Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100501values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
502otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
503numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
504for every keyword. Supported units are :
505
506 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
507 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
508 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
509 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
510 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
511 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
512
513
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005142.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200515-------------
516
517 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
518 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
519 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
520 global
521 daemon
522 maxconn 256
523
524 defaults
525 mode http
526 timeout connect 5000ms
527 timeout client 50000ms
528 timeout server 50000ms
529
530 frontend http-in
531 bind *:80
532 default_backend servers
533
534 backend servers
535 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
536
537
538 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
539 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
540 global
541 daemon
542 maxconn 256
543
544 defaults
545 mode http
546 timeout connect 5000ms
547 timeout client 50000ms
548 timeout server 50000ms
549
550 listen http-in
551 bind *:80
552 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
553
554
555Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
556
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100557 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200558
559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005603. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200561--------------------
562
563Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
564are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
565of them have command-line equivalents.
566
567The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
568
569 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200570 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200571 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200572 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200575 - description
576 - deviceatlas-json-file
577 - deviceatlas-log-level
578 - deviceatlas-separator
579 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900580 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200581 - gid
582 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100583 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200584 - h1-case-adjust
585 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100588 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200590 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200592 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200593 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100595 - presetenv
596 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - uid
598 - ulimit-n
599 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200600 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100601 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200602 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200603 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200604 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - ssl-default-bind-options
606 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200607 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - ssl-default-server-options
609 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100610 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100611 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100612 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100613 - 51degrees-data-file
614 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200615 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200616 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200617 - wurfl-data-file
618 - wurfl-information-list
619 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200620 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100621
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200622 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200623 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200624 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200625 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100626 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100627 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100628 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200629 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200630 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200631 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200632 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633 - noepoll
634 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000635 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100637 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300638 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000639 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100640 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200641 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200642 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200643 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000644 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000645 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200646 - tune.buffers.limit
647 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200648 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200649 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100650 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200651 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200652 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200653 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100654 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200655 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200656 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100657 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100658 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100659 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100660 - tune.lua.session-timeout
661 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200662 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100663 - tune.maxaccept
664 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200665 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200666 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200667 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua5e11c02020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200668 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
669 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100670 - tune.rcvbuf.client
671 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100672 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200673 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100674 - tune.sndbuf.client
675 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100676 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100677 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200678 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100679 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200680 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200681 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100682 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200683 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100684 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200685 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
686 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
687 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100688 - tune.zlib.memlevel
689 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100690
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200691 * Debugging
692 - debug
693 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200694
695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006963.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200697------------------------------------
698
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200699ca-base <dir>
700 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200701 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
702 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200703
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200704chroot <jail dir>
705 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
706 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
707 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
708 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
709 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100710 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100711
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
713 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
714 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
715 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
716 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
717 set. These sets have the format
718
719 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
720
721 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100722 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100723 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
724 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100725 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
726 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100727 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100728 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100729 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100730 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100731 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
732 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
733 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
734 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100735
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100736 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
737 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
738 on the machine's word size.
739
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100740 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100741 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
742 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
743 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
744 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
745 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
746 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100747
748 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100749 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
750
751 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
752 # first 4 CPUs
753
754 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
755 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
756 # word size.
757
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100758 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100760 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
761 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
762 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
763
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100764 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
765 # and so on.
766 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
767 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
768 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
769
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100770 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100771 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
772 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
773 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
774
775 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
776 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
777 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
778
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100779 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
780 # and a thread range.
781 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
782 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
783 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
784
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200785crt-base <dir>
786 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
787 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
788 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
789
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200790daemon
791 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
792 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100793 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
794 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200795
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200796deviceatlas-json-file <path>
797 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100798 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200799
800deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100801 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200802 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
803
804deviceatlas-separator <char>
805 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
806 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
807
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100808deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200809 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
810 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
811 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100812
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900813external-check
814 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
815 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
816 See "option external-check".
817
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200818gid <number>
819 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
820 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
821 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100822 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
823 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200824 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100825
Willy Tarreau8b852462019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100826group <group name>
827 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
828 See also "gid" and "user".
829
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100830hard-stop-after <time>
831 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
832
833 Arguments :
834 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
835 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
836 SIGUSR1 signal.
837
838 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
839 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
840 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
841
842 Example:
843 global
844 hard-stop-after 30s
845
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200846h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
847 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
848 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
849 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
850 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin5c836fd2020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500851 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200852 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
853 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
854 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
855 specified in a proxy.
856
857 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
858 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
859 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
860 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
861 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
862 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
863 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
864
865 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
866 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
867 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
868 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
869 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
870
871 Example:
872 global
873 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
874
875 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
876 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
877
878h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
879 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
880 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
881 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
882 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
883 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
884 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
885 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
886 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
887
888 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
889 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
890 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
891
892 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
893 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
894
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200895log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
896 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100897 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100898 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100899 configured with "log global".
900
901 <address> can be one of:
902
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100903 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100904 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
905 port).
906
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100907 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
908 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
909 port).
910
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100911 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100912 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
913 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100914 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100915
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100916 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
917 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
918 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
919 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
920 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
921 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
922 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
923 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
924 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
925 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
926 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
927 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
928 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
929 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100930 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
931 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100932
933 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
934 "fd@2", see above.
935
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200936 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
937 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100938
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200939 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
940 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
941 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
942 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
943 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
944 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
945 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
946 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
947 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
948 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100949 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
950 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200951
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200952 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
953 one of the following :
954
955 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
956 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
957
958 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
959 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
960
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100961 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
962 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
963 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
964 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
965 logger consumes.
966
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100967 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
968 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
969 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
970 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
971
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200972 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
973 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
974 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
975 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
976 set with <sample_size> parameter.
977
978 <sample_size>
979 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
980 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
981 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
982 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
983 (see also <ranges> parameter).
984
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100985 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200986
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100987 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
988 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
989 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
990
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100991 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
992 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
993 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
994 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995
996 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200997 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
998 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
999 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1000 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1001 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1002 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001003
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001004 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001005
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001006log-send-hostname [<string>]
1007 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1008 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1009 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1010 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1011 the logs.
1012
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001013log-tag <string>
1014 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1015 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1016 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001017 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001018
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001019lua-load <file>
1020 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1021 used multiple times.
1022
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001023master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001024 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1025 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1026 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001027 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001028 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1029 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001030 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1031 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1032 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1033 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1034 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001035
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001036 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001037
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001038mworker-max-reloads <number>
1039 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001040 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001041 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1042 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1043 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1044
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001045nbproc <number>
1046 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1047 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1048 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001049 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1050 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001051 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1052 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001053
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001054nbthread <number>
1055 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001056 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1057 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1058 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1059 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1060 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001061 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1062 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1063 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1064 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1065 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1066 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1067 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001068
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001069pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001070 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001071 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1072 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1073
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001074presetenv <name> <value>
1075 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1076 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1077 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1078 and "unsetenv".
1079
1080resetenv [<name> ...]
1081 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1082 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1083 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1084 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1085 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1086 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1087 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1088 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1089
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001090stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001091 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1092 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1093 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1094 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1095 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1096 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001097 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001098 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1099 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1100 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1101 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001102
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001103server-state-base <directory>
1104 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001105 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1106 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001107
1108server-state-file <file>
1109 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1110 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1111 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1112 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1113 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1114 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1115 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1116 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001117 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1118 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001119
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001120setenv <name> <value>
1121 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1122 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1123 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1124 and "unsetenv".
1125
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001126set-dumpable
1127 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1128 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1129 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1130 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1131 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1132 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1133 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1134 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1135 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1136 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1137 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1138 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1139 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1140 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1141 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1142 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1143 expected when dying.
1144
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001145ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1147 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001148 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001149 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001150 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1151 information and recommendations see e.g.
1152 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1153 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1154 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1155 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001156
1157ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1158 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1159 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1160 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1161 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1162 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001163 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1164 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1165 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001166 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001167
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001168ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1169 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1170 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1171 keyword to see available options.
1172
1173 Example:
1174 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001175 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001176
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001177ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1178 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1179 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001180 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001181 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001182 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1183 information and recommendations see e.g.
1184 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1185 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1186 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1187 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1188 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001189
1190ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1191 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1192 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1193 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1194 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1195 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001196 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1197 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1198 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1199 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001200
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001201ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1202 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1203 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1204 keyword to see available options.
1205
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001206ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1207 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1208 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1209 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001210 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001211 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001212 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1213 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1214 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1215 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001216 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1217 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1218 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1219
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001220ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1221 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1222 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1223 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1224
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001225stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1226 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1227 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1228 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001229 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001230 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001231
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001232 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1233 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1234 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001235
1236stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1237 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1238 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001239 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001240
1241stats maxconn <connections>
1242 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1243 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1244
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001245uid <number>
1246 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1247 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1248 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1249 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1250
1251ulimit-n <number>
1252 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1253 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1254 option.
1255
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001256unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1257 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1258
1259 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1260 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1261 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1262 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1263 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1264 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1265 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1266 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1267 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1268 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1269
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001270unsetenv [<name> ...]
1271 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1272 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1273 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1274 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1275 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1276 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1277 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1278
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001279user <user name>
1280 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1281 See also "uid" and "group".
1282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001283node <name>
1284 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1285
1286 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1287 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1288 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1289 traffic.
1290
1291description <text>
1292 Add a text that describes the instance.
1293
1294 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1295 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1296 "<" and ">" characters.
1297
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100129851degrees-data-file <file path>
1299 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001300 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001301
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001302 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001303 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1304
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000130551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001306 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1307 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1308 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1309
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001310 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001311 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1312
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200131351degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001314 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1315 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1316
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001317 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1318 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1319
132051degrees-cache-size <number>
1321 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1322 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1323 By default, this cache is disabled.
1324
1325 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001326 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1327
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001328wurfl-data-file <file path>
1329 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1330 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1331
1332 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1333 with USE_WURFL=1.
1334
1335wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1336 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1337 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1338 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1339
1340 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1341
1342 Valid WURFL properties are:
1343 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1344
1345 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1346 device.
1347
1348 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1349 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1350
1351 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1352 particular web request.
1353
1354 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1355 used Libwurfl API version.
1356
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001357 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1358 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1359
1360 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1361 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1362
1363 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1364
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001365 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1366 with USE_WURFL=1.
1367
1368wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1369 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1370 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1371
1372 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1373 with USE_WURFL=1.
1374
1375wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1376 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1377 thus before the chroot.
1378
1379 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1380 with USE_WURFL=1.
1381
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001382wurfl-cache-size <size>
1383 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1384 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001385 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001386 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001387
1388 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1389 with USE_WURFL=1.
1390
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013913.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001392-----------------------
1393
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001394busy-polling
1395 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1396 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1397 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1398 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1399 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1400 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1401 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1402 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1403 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1404 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1405 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1406 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1407 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1408 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1409 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1410 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1411 "poll" pollers.
1412
William Dauchy857b9432019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001413 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1414 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1415 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1416
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001417max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1418 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1419 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1420 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1421 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1422 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1423 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1424 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1425 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1426
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001427maxconn <number>
1428 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1429 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1430 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001431 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1432 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1433 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1434 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001435 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1436 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1437 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1438 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1439 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1440 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001441
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001442maxconnrate <number>
1443 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1444 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1445 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1446 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1447 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1448 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1449 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1450 fairness.
1451
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001452maxcomprate <number>
1453 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001454 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001455 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1456 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1457 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001458 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001459 default value.
1460
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001461maxcompcpuusage <number>
1462 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1463 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1464 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1465 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1466 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1467 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1468 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1469 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1470
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001471maxpipes <number>
1472 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1473 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1474 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1475 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1476 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1477 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1478
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001479maxsessrate <number>
1480 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1481 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1482 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1483 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1484 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1485 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1486 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1487 fairness.
1488
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001489maxsslconn <number>
1490 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1491 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1492 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1493 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1494 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1495 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1496 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001497 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1498 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1499 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1500 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1501 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1502 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1503 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001504
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001505maxsslrate <number>
1506 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1507 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1508 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1509 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1510 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1511 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1512 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1513 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1514 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1515 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1516
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001517maxzlibmem <number>
1518 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1519 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1520 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001521 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1522 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1523 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1524
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001525noepoll
1526 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1527 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001528 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001529
1530nokqueue
1531 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1532 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1533 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1534
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001535noevports
1536 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1537 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1538 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1539 also "nopoll".
1540
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001541nopoll
1542 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1543 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001544 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001545 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1546 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001547
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001548nosplice
1549 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001550 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001551 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001552 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001553 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1554 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1555 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1556 "option splice-response".
1557
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001558nogetaddrinfo
1559 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1560 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1561
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001562noreuseport
1563 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1564 command line argument "-dR".
1565
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001566profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1567 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1568 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1569 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1570 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001571 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001572 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1573 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1574 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1575 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1576
1577 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1578 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1579 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1580 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1581 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001582 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1583 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1584 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1585 CLI.
1586
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001587spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001588 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1589 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1590 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1591 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1592 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1593 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001594
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001595ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001596 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001597 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001598 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1599 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1600 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1601 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1602 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001603 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1604 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001605 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1606 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1607 openssl configuration file uses:
1608 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1609
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001610ssl-mode-async
1611 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001612 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001613 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1614 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1615 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001616 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001617 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001618
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001619tune.buffers.limit <number>
1620 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1621 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1622 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1623 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1624 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001625 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001626 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1627 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1628 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1629 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1630 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1631 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1632 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1633 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1634 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1635
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001636tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1637 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1638 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1639 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1640 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1641
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001642tune.bufsize <number>
1643 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1644 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1645 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1646 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1647 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1648 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1649 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001650 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1651 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1652 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001653 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001654 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1655 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1656 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001657
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001658tune.chksize <number>
1659 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1660 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1661 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1662 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1663 checks whenever possible.
1664
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001665tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1666 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1667 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1668 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1669 this value. The default value is 1.
1670
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001671tune.fail-alloc
1672 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1673 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1674 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1675 gracefully.
1676
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001677tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1678 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1679 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1680 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1681 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1682 change it.
1683
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001684tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1685 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001686 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1687 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001688 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1689 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1690 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1691 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1692 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1693
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001694tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1695 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1696 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1697 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1698 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1699 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1700 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1701 recommended not to change this value.
1702
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001703tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1704 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1705 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1706 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1707 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1708 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1709 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1710 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1711
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001712tune.http.cookielen <number>
1713 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1714 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1715 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1716 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1717 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1718 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1719 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1720 to change this value.
1721
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001722tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001723 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1724 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001725 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001726 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001727 configuration directives too.
1728 The default value is 1024.
1729
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001730tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1731 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1732 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1733 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1734 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1735 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1736 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001737 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1738 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1739 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001740
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001741tune.idletimer <timeout>
1742 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1743 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1744 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1745 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1746 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1747 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001748 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001749 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001750 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1751
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001752tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1753 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1754 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1755 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1756 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1757 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1758 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1759 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1760 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1761 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1762
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001763tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1764 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001765 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001766 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1767 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001768 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001769 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1770 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1771
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001772tune.lua.maxmem
1773 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1774 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1775 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1776 memory.
1777
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001778tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1779 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001780 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1781 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001782 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001783
1784tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1785 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1786 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1787 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1788 check servers.
1789
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001790tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1791 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1792 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1793 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001794 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001795
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001796tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001797 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1798 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1799 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1800 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1801 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1802 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1803 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1804 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1805 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1806 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001807
1808tune.maxpollevents <number>
1809 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1810 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1811 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1812 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1813 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1814
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001815tune.maxrewrite <number>
1816 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1817 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1818 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1819 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1820 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1821 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1822 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1823 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1824 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1825 bufsize.
1826
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001827tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1828 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1829 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1830 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1831 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1832 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1833 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1834 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1835 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1836 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau7fdd81c2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001837 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1838 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001839 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1840 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1841 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1842 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1843 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1844 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1845 setting this parameter to 0.
1846
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001847tune.pipesize <number>
1848 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1849 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1850 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1851 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1852 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1853 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1854
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001855tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1856 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1857 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1858 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1859 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1860 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1861 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001862 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001863
Willy Tarreauc55e3e12020-07-01 18:30:16 +02001864tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1865 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1866 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1867 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1868 default is 20.
1869
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001870tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1871tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1872 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1873 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1874 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001875 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001876 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001877 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1878 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1879
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001880tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001881 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001882 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1883 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1884 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1885 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1886
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001887tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001888 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001889 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1890 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1891
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001892tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1893tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1894 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1895 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1896 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001897 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001898 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001899 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1900 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1901 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1902 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1903 notifying haproxy again.
1904
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001905tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001906 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1907 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1908 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001909 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001910 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001911 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001912 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1913 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1914 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001915 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1916 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001917
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001918tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001919 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001920 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1921 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1922 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1923 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1924 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1925
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001926tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1927 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001928 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001929 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1930 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1931 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1932 being used for too long.
1933
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001934tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1935 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1936 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1937 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1938 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1939 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1940 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1941 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1942 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1943 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1944 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001945 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001946 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001947
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001948tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1949 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1950 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1951 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1952 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1953 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1954 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1955 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001956 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1957 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001958
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001959tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1960 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1961 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1962 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1963 1000 entries.
1964
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001965tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1966 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1967 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1968 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1969
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001970tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001971tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001972tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1973tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1974tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001975 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1976 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1977 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1978 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1979 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1980 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1981 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1982 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001983
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001984 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1985 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1986 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1987 all available space is consumed.
1988 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1989 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1990 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001991
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001992tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1993 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001994 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001995 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001996 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001997 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1998
1999tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2000 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2001 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002002 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2003 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020053.3. Debugging
2006--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002007
2008debug
2009 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2010 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2011 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2012 system startup.
2013
2014quiet
2015 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2016 line argument "-q".
2017
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020193.4. Userlists
2020--------------
2021It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2022http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2023it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2024
2025userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002026 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002027 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2028
2029group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002030 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002031 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2032 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2033
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002034user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2035 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002036 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2037 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002038 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2039 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2040 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2041 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002042
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002043 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2044 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2045 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2046 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2047 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2048 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2049 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2050 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2051 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002052
2053 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002054 userlist L1
2055 group G1 users tiger,scott
2056 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002057
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002058 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2059 user scott insecure-password elgato
2060 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002061
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002062 userlist L2
2063 group G1
2064 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002065
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002066 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2067 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2068 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002069
2070 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002071
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002072
20733.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002074----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002075It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2076several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2077instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2078values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2079automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2080In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2081using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2082tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2083reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2084Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2085that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2086each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002087
2088peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002089 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002090 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2091
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002092bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2093 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2094 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2095
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002096disabled
2097 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2098 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2099 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2100
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002101default-bind [param*]
2102 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2103
2104default-server [param*]
2105 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2106
2107 Arguments:
2108 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2109 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2110 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2111 details.
2112
2113
2114 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2115
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002116enable
2117 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2118
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002119peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002120 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2121 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2122 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2123 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2124 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2125 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2126
2127 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2128 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2129
2130 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2131 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2132 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2133 across all peers.
2134
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002135 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2136 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002137
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002138 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2139 "server" keyword explanation below).
2140
2141server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002142 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002143 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2144 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2145 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2146 of this "peers" section).
2147 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2148
2149
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002150 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002151 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002152 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002153 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2154 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2155 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002156
2157 backend mybackend
2158 mode tcp
2159 balance roundrobin
2160 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2161 stick on src
2162
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002163 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2164 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002165
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002166 Example:
2167 peers mypeers
2168 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2169 default-server ssl verify none
2170 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2171 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002172
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002173
2174table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2175 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2176
2177 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2178 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002179 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002180 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2181 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2182 "stick-table" keyword).
2183
2184 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2185 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2186 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2187 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2188 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2189 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2190 of the stick-table name as follows:
2191
2192 peers mypeers
2193 peer A ...
2194 peer B ...
2195 table t1 ...
2196
2197 frontend fe1
2198 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2199
2200 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2201 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2202
2203 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2204 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2205 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2206 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2207 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2208 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2209 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2210
2211 peers mypeers
2212 peer A ...
2213 peer B ...
2214 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2215
2216 backend t1
2217 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2218
2219 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2220 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2221 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2222
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022233.6. Mailers
2224------------
2225It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2226If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2227in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2228
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002229mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002230 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2231 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2232
2233mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2234 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2235
2236 Example:
2237 mailers mymailers
2238 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2239 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2240
2241 backend mybackend
2242 mode tcp
2243 balance roundrobin
2244
2245 email-alert mailers mymailers
2246 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2247 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2248
2249 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2250 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2251
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002252timeout mail <time>
2253 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2254 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2255 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2256 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2257
2258 Example:
2259 mailers mymailers
2260 timeout mail 20s
2261 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002262
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022633.7. Programs
2264-------------
2265In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2266master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2267managed the same way as the workers.
2268
2269During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2270sequence as a worker:
2271
2272 - the master is re-executed
2273 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2274 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2275 instance of the program
2276
2277During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2278
2279program <name>
2280 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2281 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2282 the management guide).
2283
2284command <command> [arguments*]
2285 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2286 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2287 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2288 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2289
2290option start-on-reload
2291no option start-on-reload
2292 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2293 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2294 program section.
2295
2296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022974. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002298----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002299
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002300Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002301 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002302 - frontend <name>
2303 - backend <name>
2304 - listen <name>
2305
2306A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2307its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2308section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002309section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002310
2311A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2312connections.
2313
2314A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2315to forward incoming connections.
2316
2317A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2318parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2319
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002320All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2321'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2322case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2323
2324Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2325logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2326proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2327However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2328name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2329
2330Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2331and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002332bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002333protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2334modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2335arbitrary criteria.
2336
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002337In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2338a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto599788e2019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002339the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002340
2341 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2342 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2343 between responses and new requests.
2344
2345 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2346 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2347 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002348 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2349 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2350 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2351 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002352
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002353 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2354 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2355 client-facing connection remains open.
2356
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002357 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2358 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002359
2360The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2361frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2362following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002363weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002364
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002365 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002366
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002367 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2368 ----+-----+-----+----
2369 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2370 ----+-----+-----+----
2371 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2372 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2373 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2374 ----+-----+-----+----
2375 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002376
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002377
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023794.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2380--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002381
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002382The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2383limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2384they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2385limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002386marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002387option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002388and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2389with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2390specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002391
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002392
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002393 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2394------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2395acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002396backlog X X X -
2397balance X - X X
2398bind - X X -
2399bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002400block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002401capture cookie - X X -
2402capture request header - X X -
2403capture response header - X X -
2404clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002405compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002406contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2407cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002408declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002409default-server X - X X
2410default_backend X X X -
2411description - X X X
2412disabled X X X X
2413dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002414email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002415email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002416email-alert mailers X X X X
2417email-alert myhostname X X X X
2418email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002419enabled X X X X
2420errorfile X X X X
2421errorloc X X X X
2422errorloc302 X X X X
2423-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2424errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002425force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002426filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002427fullconn X - X X
2428grace X X X X
2429hash-type X - X X
2430http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002431http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002432http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002433http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002434http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002435http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002436http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002437id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002438ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002439load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002440log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002441log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002442log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002443log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002444max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002445maxconn X X X -
2446mode X X X X
2447monitor fail - X X -
2448monitor-net X X X -
2449monitor-uri X X X -
2450option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2451option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2452option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2453option allbackups (*) X - X X
2454option checkcache (*) X - X X
2455option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2456option contstats (*) X X X -
2457option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2458option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002459-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2460option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002461option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2462option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002463option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002464option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002465option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002466option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002467option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002468option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002469option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002470option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002471option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002472option httpchk X - X X
2473option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002474option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002475option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002476option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002477option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002478option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002479option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2480option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2481option logasap (*) X X X -
2482option mysql-check X - X X
2483option nolinger (*) X X X X
2484option originalto X X X X
2485option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002486option pgsql-check X - X X
2487option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002488option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002489option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002490option smtpchk X - X X
2491option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2492option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2493option splice-request (*) X X X X
2494option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002495option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002496option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2497option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2498-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002499option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002500option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2501option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2502option tcpka X X X X
2503option tcplog X X X X
2504option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002505external-check command X - X X
2506external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002507persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2508rate-limit sessions X X X -
2509redirect - X X X
2510redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2511redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002512reqadd (deprecated) - X X X
2513reqallow (deprecated) - X X X
2514reqdel (deprecated) - X X X
2515reqdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2516reqiallow (deprecated) - X X X
2517reqidel (deprecated) - X X X
2518reqideny (deprecated) - X X X
2519reqipass (deprecated) - X X X
2520reqirep (deprecated) - X X X
2521reqitarpit (deprecated) - X X X
2522reqpass (deprecated) - X X X
2523reqrep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002524-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002525reqtarpit (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002526retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002527retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002528rspadd (deprecated) - X X X
2529rspdel (deprecated) - X X X
2530rspdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2531rspidel (deprecated) - X X X
2532rspideny (deprecated) - X X X
2533rspirep (deprecated) - X X X
2534rsprep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002535server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002536server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002537server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002538source X - X X
2539srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002540stats admin - X X X
2541stats auth X X X X
2542stats enable X X X X
2543stats hide-version X X X X
2544stats http-request - X X X
2545stats realm X X X X
2546stats refresh X X X X
2547stats scope X X X X
2548stats show-desc X X X X
2549stats show-legends X X X X
2550stats show-node X X X X
2551stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002552-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2553stick match - - X X
2554stick on - - X X
2555stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002556stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002557stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002558tcp-check connect - - X X
2559tcp-check expect - - X X
2560tcp-check send - - X X
2561tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002562tcp-request connection - X X -
2563tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002564tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002565tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002566tcp-response content - - X X
2567tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002568timeout check X - X X
2569timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002570timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002571timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2572timeout connect X - X X
2573timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2574timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2575timeout http-request X X X X
2576timeout queue X - X X
2577timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002578timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002579timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2580timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002581timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002582transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002583unique-id-format X X X -
2584unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002585use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002586use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002587------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2588 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002589
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025914.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2592---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002593
2594This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2595
2596
2597acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2598 Declare or complete an access list.
2599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2600 no | yes | yes | yes
2601 Example:
2602 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2603 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2604 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002606 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002607
2608
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002609backlog <conns>
2610 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2612 yes | yes | yes | no
2613 Arguments :
2614 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2615 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002616 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002617
2618 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2619 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2620 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2621 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2622 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2623 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2624 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2625 backlog parameter.
2626
2627 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2628 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2629 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2630
2631 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2632
2633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002634balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002635balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002636 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2638 yes | no | yes | yes
2639 Arguments :
2640 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2641 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2642 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2643 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2644
2645 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2646 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2647 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2648 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002649 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002650 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002651 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2652 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2653 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2654 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2655 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2656 it, so that you don't worry.
2657
2658 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2659 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2660 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2661 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2662 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2663 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2664 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2665 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002666
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002667 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2668 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2669 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2670 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2671 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2672 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2673 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2674 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2675
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002676 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002677 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002678 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2679 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002680 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002681 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2682 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2683 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2684 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2685 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002686 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2687 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2688 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2689 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2690 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2691 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002692
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002693 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2694 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2695 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2696 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2697 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2698 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2699 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2700 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002701 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002702 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002703 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2704 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2705 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002706
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002707 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2708 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2709 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2710 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2711 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2712 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2713 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2714 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2715 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2716 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2717 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2718 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002719
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002720 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002721 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2722 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2723 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2724 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2725 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2726 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2727 URIs start with a leading "/".
2728
2729 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2730 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2731 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2732 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2733
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002734 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002735 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2736
2737 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002738 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2739 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002740 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2741 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2742 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2743 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002744 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002745 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2746 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002747
2748 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2749 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2750 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2751 server will receive the request.
2752
2753 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2754 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2755 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2756 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2757 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002758 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2759 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2760 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002761
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002762 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2763 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2764 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2765 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2766 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002767
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002768 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002769 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2770 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2771 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2772
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002773 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2774 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2775 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2776
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002777 random
2778 random(<draws>)
2779 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002780 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2781 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2782 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2783 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002784 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2785 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2786 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2787 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2788 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2789 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2790 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2791 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2792 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2793 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2794 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2795 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2796 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2797 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2798 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2799 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2800 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2801 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2802 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2803 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002804
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002805 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002806 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002807 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2808 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2809 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2810 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2811 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2812 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002813 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002814 used instead.
2815
2816 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2817 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2818 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2819 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2820
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002821 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2822 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2823 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2824
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002825 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002826
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002827 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002828 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2829 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002830
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002831 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2832 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2833 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002834
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002835 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002836 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002837 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2838 NTLM relies on.
2839
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002840 Examples :
2841 balance roundrobin
2842 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002843 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002844 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2845 balance hdr(host)
2846 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002847
2848 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2849 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2850
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002851 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002852 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2853 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2854 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2855 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2856
2857 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2858 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2859 defaults to 16 kB.
2860
2861 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2862 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2863
2864 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2865 Round Robin.
2866
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002867 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002868 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2869 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2870 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2871
2872 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2873
2874 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002875 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002876 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2877 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2878 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002879
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002880 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002881
2882
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002883bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2884bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002885 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2887 no | yes | yes | no
2888 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002889 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2890 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2891 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2892 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002893 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002894 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2895 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2896 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2897 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2898 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2899 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2900 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002901 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2902 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2903 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2904 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2905 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2906 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2907 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002908 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2909 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2910 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002911 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2912 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2913 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2914 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002915 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2916 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2917 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002918
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002919 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2920 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002921 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2922 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2923 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002924 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2925 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2926 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2927 the range.
2928
2929 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2930 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2931 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2932 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2933 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2934 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2935 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002936 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002937 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002938
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002939 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002940 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002941 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2942 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2943 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2944 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2945 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2946 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2947
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002948 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2949 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2950 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2951 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002952
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002953 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2954 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2955 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2956 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2957 in a frontend.
2958
2959 Example :
2960 listen http_proxy
2961 bind :80,:443
2962 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002963 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002965 listen http_https_proxy
2966 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002967 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002968
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002969 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2970 bind ipv6@:80
2971 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2972 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2973
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002974 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002975 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002976
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002977 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2978 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2979 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2980 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2981 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2982
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002983 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002984 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002985
2986
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002987bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002988 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2990 yes | yes | yes | yes
2991 Arguments :
2992 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2993 may be used to override a default value.
2994
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002995 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002996 option may be combined with other numbers.
2997
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002998 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002999 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3000 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3001 missing from all processes.
3002
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003003 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003004 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003005 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3006 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3007 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3008 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3009 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003010 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003011
3012 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3013 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3014 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3015 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3016 and 'even' instances.
3017
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003018 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3019 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3020 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3021 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003022
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003023 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3024 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3025
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003026 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3027 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3028 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3029
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003030 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3031 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3032
3033 Example :
3034 listen app_ip1
3035 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003036 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003037
3038 listen app_ip2
3039 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003040 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003041
3042 listen management
3043 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003044 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003045
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003046 listen management
3047 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3048 bind-process 1-4
3049
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003050 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003051
3052
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003053block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003054 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
3055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3056 no | yes | yes | yes
3057
3058 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
3059 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003060 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003061 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003062 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003063 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
3064 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
3065 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003066
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003067 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
3068 "http-request deny" instead.
3069
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003070 Example:
3071 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3072 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3073 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03003074 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
3075 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
3076 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003077
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003078 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
3079 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
3080 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003081
3082capture cookie <name> len <length>
3083 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3085 no | yes | yes | no
3086 Arguments :
3087 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3088 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3089 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3090 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003091 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003092
3093 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3094 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3095 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3096 right if it exceeds <length>.
3097
3098 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3099 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3100 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3101 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3102
3103 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3104 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3105 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3106
3107 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3108 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3109 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003110 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3111 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3112 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003113
3114 Example:
3115 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3116
3117 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003118 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003119
3120
3121capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003122 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3124 no | yes | yes | no
3125 Arguments :
3126 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003127 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003128 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3129 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3130 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3131
3132 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3133 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3134 it exceeds <length>.
3135
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003136 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003137 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3138 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003139 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3140 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3141 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3142 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003143 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003144 environments to find where the request came from.
3145
3146 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3147 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3148 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3149 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003150
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003151 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3152 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3153 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3154 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3155 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003156
3157 Example:
3158 capture request header Host len 15
3159 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003160 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003162 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003163 about logging.
3164
3165
3166capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003167 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3169 no | yes | yes | no
3170 Arguments :
3171 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003172 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003173 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3174 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3175 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3176
3177 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3178 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3179 it exceeds <length>.
3180
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003181 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003182 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3183 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3184 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003185 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3186 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3187 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3188 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003189
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003190 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3191 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3192 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3193 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3194 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003195
3196 Example:
3197 capture response header Content-length len 9
3198 capture response header Location len 15
3199
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003200 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003201 about logging.
3202
3203
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003204clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003205 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3207 yes | yes | yes | no
3208 Arguments :
3209 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3210 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3211 as explained at the top of this document.
3212
3213 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3214 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3215 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3216 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3217 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3218 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3219 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3220 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003221 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003222 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003223 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003224
3225 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3226 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3227 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3228 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3229 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3230 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3231
3232 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3233 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3234
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003235 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3236 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003237
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003238compression algo <algorithm> ...
3239compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003240compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003241 Enable HTTP compression.
3242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3243 yes | yes | yes | yes
3244 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003245 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3246 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3247 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3248
3249 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003250 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3251 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3252 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003253
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003254 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003255 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003256
3257 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3258 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3259 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3260 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3261 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003262 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003263
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003264 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3265 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3266 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3267 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3268 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3269 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3270 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003271 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003272
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003273 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003274 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003275 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3276 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3277 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3278 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3279 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003280
3281 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3282 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3283 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3284 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3285 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003286 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3287 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3288 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3289 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3290 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003291 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3292 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003293
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003294 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003295 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3296 "Accept-Encoding" header
3297 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003298 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003299 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3300 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3301 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3302 "multipart"
3303 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3304 header
3305 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3306 and later
3307 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3308 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003309 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003310
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003311 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003312
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003313 Examples :
3314 compression algo gzip
3315 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003316
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003317
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003318contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003319 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3321 yes | no | yes | yes
3322 Arguments :
3323 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3324 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3325 as explained at the top of this document.
3326
3327 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003328 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003329 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003330 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003331 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3332 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3333 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3334
3335 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3336 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3337 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3338 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3339 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3340 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3341
3342 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3343 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3344 instead.
3345
3346 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3347 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3348
3349
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003350cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003351 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3352 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003353 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003354 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3356 yes | no | yes | yes
3357 Arguments :
3358 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3359 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3360 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3361 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3362 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3363 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003364 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003365 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3366 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3367
3368 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3369 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3370 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3371 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3372 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3373 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003374 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3375 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003376 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003377 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3378 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003379
3380 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003381 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003382
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003383 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003384 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003385 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003386 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003387 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3388 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3389 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3390 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3391 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3392 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3393 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003394
3395 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3396 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3397 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3398 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3399 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3400 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3401 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3402 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3403 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003404 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003405 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3406 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3407 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003408
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003409 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3410 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3411 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003412 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3413 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3414 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3415 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003416 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3417 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3418 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003419
3420 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3421 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3422 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3423 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3424 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3425 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3426 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3427 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3428 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3429
3430 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3431 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3432 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3433 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3434 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3435 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3436 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3437 persistence cookie in the cache.
3438 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3439
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003440 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3441 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3442 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3443 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3444 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003445 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003446 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3447 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3448 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3449 they logout.
3450
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003451 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3452 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3453 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3454 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3455
3456 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3457 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3458 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3459 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3460 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3461 this attribute.
3462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003463 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003464 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003465 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3466 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3467 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3468 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3469 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3470 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003471
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003472 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3473 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3474 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3475 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3476 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3477 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3478 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3479 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003480 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003481 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3482 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3483 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3484 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3485 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3486 the site.
3487
3488 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3489 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3490 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3491 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3492 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3493 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3494 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3495 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3496 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3497 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3498 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3499 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3500 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003501 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003502 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3503 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3504
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003505 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3506 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3507 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3508 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3509 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3510 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3511
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003512 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3513 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3514 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3515 repeated.
3516
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003517 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3518 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3519 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3520 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003521
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003522 Examples :
3523 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3524 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3525 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003526 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003527
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003528 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003529
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003530
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003531declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3532 Declares a capture slot.
3533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3534 no | yes | yes | no
3535 Arguments:
3536 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3537
3538 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3539 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3540 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3541 for use in the response.
3542
3543 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003544 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003545 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3546
3547
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003548default-server [param*]
3549 Change default options for a server in a backend
3550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3551 yes | no | yes | yes
3552 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003553 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3554 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3555 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3556 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003557
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003558 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003559 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3560
3561 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003562
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003563
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003564default_backend <backend>
3565 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3567 yes | yes | yes | no
3568 Arguments :
3569 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3570
3571 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3572 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3573 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3574 will catch all undetermined requests.
3575
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003576 Example :
3577
3578 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3579 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3580 default_backend dynamic
3581
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003582 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003583
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003584
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003585description <string>
3586 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3588 no | yes | yes | yes
3589 Arguments : string
3590
3591 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3592 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3593 it describes.
3594 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3595
3596
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003597disabled
3598 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3600 yes | yes | yes | yes
3601 Arguments : none
3602
3603 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3604 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3605 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3606 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3607 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3608 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3609 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3610
3611 See also : "enabled"
3612
3613
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003614dispatch <address>:<port>
3615 Set a default server address
3616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3617 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003618 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003619
3620 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3621 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3622 during start-up.
3623
3624 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3625 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3626 possible with normal servers.
3627
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003628 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003629 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3630 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3631 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3632 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3633
3634 See also : "server"
3635
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003636
3637dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3638 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3640 yes | no | yes | yes
3641 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3642
3643 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003644 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003645 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3646 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003647 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003648 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003649
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003650enabled
3651 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3653 yes | yes | yes | yes
3654 Arguments : none
3655
3656 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3657 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3658
3659 See also : "disabled"
3660
3661
3662errorfile <code> <file>
3663 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3665 yes | yes | yes | yes
3666 Arguments :
3667 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Anthonin Bonnefoyb1e94072020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003668 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429,
3669 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003670
3671 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003672 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003673 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003674 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3675 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003676
3677 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3678 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3679 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3680
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003681 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3682
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003683 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3684 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3685 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3686 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3687
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003688 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3689 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003690 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003691 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3692 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3693 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3694
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003695 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3696 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3697 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003698 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003699 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3700
3701 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3702
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003703 Example :
3704 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003705 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003706 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3707 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3708
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003709
3710errorloc <code> <url>
3711errorloc302 <code> <url>
3712 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3714 yes | yes | yes | yes
3715 Arguments :
3716 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Anthonin Bonnefoyb1e94072020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003717 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429,
3718 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003719
3720 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3721 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3722 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3723 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003724 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003725
3726 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3727 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3728 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3729
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003730 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3731
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003732 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3733 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3734 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3735 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003736 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003737 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3738 request.
3739
3740 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3741
3742
3743errorloc303 <code> <url>
3744 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3746 yes | yes | yes | yes
3747 Arguments :
3748 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Anthonin Bonnefoyb1e94072020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003749 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429,
3750 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003751
3752 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3753 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3754 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3755 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003756 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003757
3758 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3759 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3760 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3761
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003762 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3763
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003764 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3765 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3766 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3767 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003768 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003769
3770 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3771
3772
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003773email-alert from <emailaddr>
3774 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003775 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003776 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3777 yes | yes | yes | yes
3778
3779 Arguments :
3780
3781 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3782
3783 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3784 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3785
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003786 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003787 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3788 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003789
3790
3791email-alert level <level>
3792 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3793 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3794 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3795 yes | yes | yes | yes
3796
3797 Arguments :
3798
3799 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3800 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3801 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3802
3803 By default level is alert
3804
3805 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3806 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3807 for the proxy.
3808
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003809 Alerts are sent when :
3810
3811 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3812 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3813 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3814 is notice or lower
3815 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3816 and a health check status update occurs
3817
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003818 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3819 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003820 section 3.6 about mailers.
3821
3822
3823email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3824 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3825 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3826 yes | yes | yes | yes
3827
3828 Arguments :
3829
3830 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3831
3832 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3833 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3834
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003835 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3836 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003837
3838
3839email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3840 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3841 mailers.
3842 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3843 yes | yes | yes | yes
3844
3845 Arguments :
3846
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003847 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003848
3849 By default the systems hostname is used.
3850
3851 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3852 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3853 for the proxy.
3854
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003855 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3856 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003857
3858
3859email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003860 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003861 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3862 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3863 yes | yes | yes | yes
3864
3865 Arguments :
3866
3867 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3868
3869 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3870 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3871
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003872 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003873 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3874
3875
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003876force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3877 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3878 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003879 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003880
3881 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3882 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3883 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3884 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3885 marked down for maintenance operations.
3886
3887 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3888 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3889 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3890 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3891 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3892 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3893 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3894 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3895 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3896
3897 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3898 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3899 is used.
3900
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003901 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003902 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003903
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003904
3905filter <name> [param*]
3906 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3908 no | yes | yes | yes
3909 Arguments :
3910 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3911 referenced in section 9.
3912
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003913 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003914 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003915 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3916 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003917
3918 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3919 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3920
3921 Example:
3922 listen
3923 bind *:80
3924
3925 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3926 filter compression
3927 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3928
3929 compression algo gzip
3930 compression offload
3931
3932 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3933
3934 See also : section 9.
3935
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003936
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003937fullconn <conns>
3938 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3940 yes | no | yes | yes
3941 Arguments :
3942 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3943 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3944
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003945 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003946 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003947 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003948 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3949 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3950 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3951 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3952 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003953 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003954
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003955 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3956 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003957 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3958 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3959 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003960
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003961 Example :
3962 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3963 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3964 # connections.
3965 backend dynamic
3966 fullconn 10000
3967 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3968 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3969
3970 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3971
3972
3973grace <time>
3974 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003976 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003977 Arguments :
3978 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3979 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3980 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3981
3982 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3983 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003984 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003985 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3986
3987 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3988 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3989 simplify it.
3990
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003991
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003992hash-balance-factor <factor>
3993 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3995 yes | no | no | yes
3996 Arguments :
3997 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3998 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003999 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004000
4001 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4002 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4003 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4004 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4005 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4006 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4007 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4008
4009 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4010 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4011 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4012 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4013 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4014
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004015 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4016 consistent hashing mechanism.
4017
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004018 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4019
4020
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004021hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004022 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4024 yes | no | yes | yes
4025 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004026 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4027 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004028
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004029 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4030 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4031 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4032 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4033 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4034 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4035 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4036 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4037 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4038 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004039
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004040 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4041 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4042 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4043 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4044 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4045 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4046 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4047 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4048 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4049 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4050 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4051 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4052 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004053 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4054 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004055
4056 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4057
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004058 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004059 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4060 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4061 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004062 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4063 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4064 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004065
4066 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4067 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004068 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4069 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4070 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4071 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4072
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004073 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4074 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4075 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4076 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4077 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4078 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4079 parameter.
4080
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004081 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4082 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4083 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4084 used on strings.
4085
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004086 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4087
4088 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4089 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4090 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4091 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4092 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4093 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4094 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4095 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4096 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4097 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4098 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4099 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004100
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004101 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4102 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4103 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004104
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004105 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004106
4107
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004108http-check disable-on-404
4109 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004111 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004112 Arguments : none
4113
4114 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4115 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4116 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4117 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4118 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4119 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4120 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4121 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004122 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4123 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4124 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4125
4126 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4127
4128
4129http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004130 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004132 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004133 Arguments :
4134 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4135 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004136 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004137 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4138 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4139 details on the supported keywords.
4140
4141 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4142 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4143 with the usual backslash ('\').
4144
4145 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4146 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4147 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4148 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4149 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4150
4151 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004152 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004153 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4154 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4155 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4156
4157 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004158 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004159 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4160 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4161 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4162 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4163
4164 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004165 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004166 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4167 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4168 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4169 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4170 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004171 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004172 trace).
4173
4174 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004175 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004176 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4177 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4178 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4179 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4180 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004181 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004182
4183 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4184 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4185 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4186 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4187 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4188 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4189 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4190 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4191
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004192 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4193 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4194 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4195
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004196 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4197 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4198
4199 Examples :
4200 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004201 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004202
4203 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004204 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004205
4206 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004207 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004208
4209 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004210 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004211
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004212 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004213
4214
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004215http-check send [hdr <name> <value>]* [body <string>]
4216 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4217 health checks.
4218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4219 yes | no | yes | yes
4220 Arguments :
4221 hdr <name> <value> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4222 <name> and whose value is defined by <value> to the
4223 request sent during HTTP health checks.
4224
4225 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent
4226 sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4227 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added
4228 to the request.
4229
4230 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4231 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4232 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
4233 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. The old trick consisting to
4234 add headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
4235 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4236 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4237 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4238
4239 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect"
4240
4241
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004242http-check send-state
4243 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4245 yes | no | yes | yes
4246 Arguments : none
4247
4248 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4249 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4250 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4251 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4252 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4253
4254 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4255 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4256 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4257 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4258 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004259 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4260 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4261 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4262
4263 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4264 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4265 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4266
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004267 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4268 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4269 checked in multiple backends.
4270
4271 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4272 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4273
4274 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4275 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4276 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4277 one fails.
4278
4279 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4280 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4281 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4282
4283 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4284 server's queue.
4285
4286 Example of a header received by the application server :
4287 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4288 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4289
4290 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4291
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004292
4293http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004294 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4295
4296 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4297 no | yes | yes | yes
4298
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004299 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4300 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4301 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4302 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4303 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004304
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004305 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4306 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004307
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004308 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004309
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004310 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4311 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4312 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4313 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004314
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004315 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4316 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4317 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4318 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004319
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004320 Example:
4321 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4322 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4323 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004325 http-request allow if nagios
4326 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4327 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4328 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004330 Example:
4331 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4332 acl add path /addacl
4333 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004334
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004335 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004337 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4338 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340 Example:
4341 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4342 acl setmap path /setmap
4343 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004344
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004345 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004346
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004347 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4348 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004350 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4351 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004352
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004353http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004354
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004355 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4356 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4357 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4358 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4359 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4360 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4361 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4362 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004363
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004364http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004365
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004366 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4367 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4368 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4369 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4370 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4371 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4372 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4373 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004374
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004375http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004376
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004377 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4378 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004379
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004380
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004381http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004382
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004383 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4384 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4385 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4386 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4387 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004388
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004389 Example:
4390 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4391 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004392
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004393http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004394
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004395 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004397http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4398 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004400 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4401 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4402 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4403 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4404 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4405 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4406 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4407 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4408 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004409
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004410 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4411 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4412 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann63b220d2020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004413 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4414
4415 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4416 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4417 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4418 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004419
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004420http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004421
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004422 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4423 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4424 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4425 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4426 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4427 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004428
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004429http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004430
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004431 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004432
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004433http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004434
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004435 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4436 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4437 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4438 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4439 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4440 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004441
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004442http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004444 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4445 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4446 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4447 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4448 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004449
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004450http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4451 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4452 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4453 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4454
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004455http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4456
4457 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4458 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4459 pointed by <resolvers>.
4460 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4461 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4462 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4463 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4464 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4465 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4466 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4467 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4468 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4469 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4470 to 0.0.0.0.
4471
4472 Example:
4473 resolvers mydns
4474 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4475 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4476 timeout retry 1s
4477 hold valid 10s
4478 hold nx 3s
4479 hold other 3s
4480 hold obsolete 0s
4481 accepted_payload_size 8192
4482
4483 frontend fe
4484 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4485 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4486 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4487
4488 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4489 # which mean DNS resolution error
4490 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4491
4492 default_backend be
4493
4494 backend b_503
4495 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4496 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4497 # 503 error page to end users
4498
4499 backend be
4500 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4501 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4502 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4503 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4504 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4505
4506 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4507 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4508
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004509http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4510
4511 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4512 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4513 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4514 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004515 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4516 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004517
4518 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4519
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004520http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004521
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004522 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4523 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4524 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4525 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4526 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004527
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004528http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004530 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4531 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4532 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4533 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004534
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004535http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4536 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004537
Ilya Shipitsin5c836fd2020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004538 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004539 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4540 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4541 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4542 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4543 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004544
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004545 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4546 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4547 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4548 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4549 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004550
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004551 Example:
4552 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4553
4554 # applied to:
4555 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4556
4557 # outputs:
4558 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4559
4560 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004561
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004562 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4563
4564 # applied to:
4565 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004566
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004567 # outputs:
4568 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004569
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004570http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4571 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4572
4573 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4574 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4575 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4576 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4577
4578 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4579 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4580 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4581
4582 Example:
4583 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4584 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4585
4586 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4587 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4588
4589 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4590 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4591 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4592 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4593
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004594http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4595 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4596
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004597 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4598 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4599 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4600 against.
4601
4602 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4603 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4604 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004605
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004606 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4607 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4608 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4609 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4610 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4611 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4612 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4613 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4614 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004615 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4616 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004617
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004618 Example:
4619 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4620 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004621
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004622 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4623 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004625http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4626 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004627
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004628 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4629 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4630 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4631 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004632
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004633 Example:
4634 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004635
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004636 # applied to:
4637 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004638
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004639 # outputs:
4640 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004642http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4643http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004644
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004645 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4646 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4647 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004649http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004650
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004651 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4652 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4653 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004655http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004656
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004657 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4658 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4659 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4660 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4661 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004662
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004663 Arguments:
4664 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4665 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004666
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004667 Example:
4668 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4669 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004671 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4672 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004674http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004675
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004676 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4677 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4678 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004679
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004680 Arguments:
4681 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4682 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004683
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004684 Example:
4685 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4686 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004687
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004688 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4689 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4690 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004692http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004693
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004694 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4695 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4696 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4697 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4698 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004700 Example:
4701 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4702 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4703 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4704 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4705 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4706 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4707 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4708 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4709 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004710
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004711http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004712
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004713 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4714 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4715 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4716 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4717 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004718
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004719http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4720 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004721
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004722 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4723 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4724 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4725 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4726 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4727 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4728 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4729 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4730 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004731
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004732http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004733
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004734 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4735 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4736 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4737 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4738 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4739 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4740 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004741
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004742http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004743
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004744 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4745 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4746 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004748http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004749
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004750 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4751 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4752 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4753 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4754 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4755 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4756 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4757 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004758
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004759http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004760
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004761 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4762 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4763 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4764 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4765 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4766 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004767
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004768 Example :
4769 # prepend the host name before the path
4770 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004771
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004772http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004773
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004774 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4775 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4776 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4777 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4778 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004779
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004780http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004781
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004782 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4783 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4784 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4785 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4786 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4787 values have higher priority.
4788 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4789 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4790 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4791 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4792 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004793
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004794http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004795
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004796 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4797 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4798 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4799 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4800 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4801 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4802 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004803
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004804 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004805
4806 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004807 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4808 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004809
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004810http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4811 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4812 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4813 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004814 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
4815 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004816
4817 Arguments :
4818 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4819 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004820
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004821 See also "option forwardfor".
4822
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004823 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004824 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4825 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4826
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004827 # After the masking this will track connections
4828 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
4829 http-request track-sc0 src
4830
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004831 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4832 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4833
4834http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4835
4836 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4837 expression.
4838
4839 Arguments:
4840 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4841 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004842
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004843 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004844 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4845 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4846
4847 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4848 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4849 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4850
4851http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4852
4853 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4854 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4855 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4856 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4857 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4858 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4859 information from the request.
4860
4861 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4862
4863http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4864
4865 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4866 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4867 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4868 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4869 path and the query string.
4870 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4871
4872http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4873
4874 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4875 inline.
4876
4877 Arguments:
4878 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4879 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4880 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4881 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4882 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4883 (request and response)
4884 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4885 processing
4886 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4887 processing
4888 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4889 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4890 and '_'.
4891
4892 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4893 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004894
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004895 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004896 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004897
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004898http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4899 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004900
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004901 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4902 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4903 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4904 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4905 agent name must be used.
4906
4907 Arguments:
4908 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4909
4910 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4911 configuration.
4912
4913http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4914
4915 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4916 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4917 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4918 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4919 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4920 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4921 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4922 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4923 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4924 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4925 action.
4926 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4927 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4928 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4929 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4930 you fully understand how it works.
4931
4932http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4933
4934 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4935 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4936 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4937 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4938 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4939 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4940 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4941 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4942 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4943 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4944 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4945 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4946 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4947
4948http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4949http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4950http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4951
4952 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4953 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4954 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4955 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4956 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4957 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4958 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4959 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4960 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4961 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4962 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4963 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4964
4965 Arguments :
4966 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4967 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4968 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4969 select which table entry to update the counters.
4970
4971 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4972 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4973 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4974 that table until the session ends.
4975
4976 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4977 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4978 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4979 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4980 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4981 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4982 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4983 useful information.
4984
4985 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4986 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4987 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4988 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4989 checks that make use of it.
4990
4991http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4992
4993 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004994
4995 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004996 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004997
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004998http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4999
5000 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5001 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5002 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5003 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5004 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5005 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5006
5007 Arguments :
5008 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5009
5010 Example:
5011 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5012
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005013http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005014
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005015 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5016 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5017 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005018
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005019
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005020http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005021 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5022
5023 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5024 no | yes | yes | yes
5025
5026 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5027 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5028 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5029 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5030 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5031 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5032
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005033 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5034 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005036 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005037
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005038 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
5039 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
5040 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
5041 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005042
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005043 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
5044 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
5045 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
5046 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005047
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005048 Example:
5049 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005050
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005051 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005052
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005053 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5054 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005055
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005056 Example:
5057 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005059 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005060
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005061 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5062 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005063
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005064 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5065 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005067http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005068
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005069 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5070 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5071 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5072 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5073 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5074 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5075 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5076 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005078http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005079
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005080 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5081 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5082 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5083 example, or to pass some internal information.
5084 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5085 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5086 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005087
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005088http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005089
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005090 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5091 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005092
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005093http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005094
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005095 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005096
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005097http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005098
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005099 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5100 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5101 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5102 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5103 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5104 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5105 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005106
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005107 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5108 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5109 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5110 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5111 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann63b220d2020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005112
5113 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5114 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5115 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5116 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005117
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005118http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005119
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005120 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5121 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5122 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5123 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5124 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5125 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005126
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005127http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005128
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005129 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005130
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005131http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005132
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005133 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5134 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5135 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5136 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5137 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5138 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005139
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005140http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005141
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005142 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
5143 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005144
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005145http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005146
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005147 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5148 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5149 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5150 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5151 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5152 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005153
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005154http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5155 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005156
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005157 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5158 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005159
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005160 Example:
5161 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005162
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005163 # applied to:
5164 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005165
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005166 # outputs:
5167 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005168
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005169 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005170
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005171http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5172 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005173
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005174 This works like "http-response replace-value" except that it works on the
5175 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005176
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005177 Example:
5178 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005179
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005180 # applied to:
5181 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005182
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005183 # outputs:
5184 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005185
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005186http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5187http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005188
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005189 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5190 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5191 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005192
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005193http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005194
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005195 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
5196 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
5197 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005198
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005199http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005200
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005201 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5202 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5203 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5204 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5205 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005206
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005207 Arguments:
5208 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005209
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005210 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5211 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005212
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005213http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005214
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005215 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5216 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5217 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005218
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005219http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5220
5221 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5222 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5223 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5224 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5225 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5226
5227http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5228
5229 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5230 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5231 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5232 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5233 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5234 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5235 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5236 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5237 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5238
5239http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5240
5241 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5242 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5243 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5244 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5245 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5246 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5247 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5248
5249http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5250
5251 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5252 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5253 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5254 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5255 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5256 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5257 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5258 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5259
5260http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5261 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5262
5263 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5264 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5265 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5266 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005267
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005268 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005269 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5270 http-response set-status 431
5271 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5272 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005273
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005274http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005275
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005276 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5277 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5278 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5279 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5280 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5281 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5282 based on some information from the request.
5283
5284 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5285
5286http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5287
5288 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5289 inline.
5290
5291 Arguments:
5292 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5293 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5294 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5295 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5296 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5297 (request and response)
5298 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5299 processing
5300 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5301 processing
5302 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5303 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5304 and '_'.
5305
5306 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5307 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005308
5309 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005310 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005311
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005312http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005313
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005314 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5315 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5316 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5317 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5318 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5319 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5320 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5321 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5322 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5323 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5324 action.
5325 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5326 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5327 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5328 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5329 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005330
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005331http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5332http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5333http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005334
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005335 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5336 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5337 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5338 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5339 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5340 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5341
5342http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5343
5344 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5345 about <var-name>.
5346
5347 Example:
5348 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5349
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005350
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005351http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5352 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5353
5354 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5355 yes | no | yes | yes
5356
5357 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005358 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5359 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5360 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005361
5362 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5363
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005364 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5365 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5366 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5367 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5368 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5369 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5370 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5371 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5372 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5373 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005374
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005375 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5376 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5377 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5378 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5379 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5380 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5381 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5382 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005383
5384 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5385 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5386 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5387 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5388 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5389 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5390 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5391 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005392 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005393 downsides of rare connection failures.
5394
5395 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5396 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5397 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5398 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5399 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5400 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005401 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005402 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5403 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5404 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5405 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5406 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5407
5408 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005409 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5410 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5411 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005412
5413 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005414 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005415
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005416 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5417 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005418
Lukas Tribus79a56932019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005419 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005420
5421 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5422 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5423 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5424
5425 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5426
5427
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005428http-send-name-header [<header>]
5429 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005430 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5431 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005432 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005433 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5434
Willy Tarreaue0e32792019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005435 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5436 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5437 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5438 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5439 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5440 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5441 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5442 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5443 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5444 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5445 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5446 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5447 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5448 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5449 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5450 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005451
5452 See also : "server"
5453
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005454id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005455 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5457 no | yes | yes | yes
5458 Arguments : none
5459
5460 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5461 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5462 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005463
5464
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005465ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5466 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5467 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005468 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005469
5470 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5471 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5472 and running).
5473
5474 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5475 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5476 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005477 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005478 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5479
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005480 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5481 "unless" condition is met.
5482
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005483 Example:
5484 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5485 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5486 ignore-persist if url_static
5487
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005488 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5489
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005490load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5491 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5492 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5493 yes | no | yes | yes
5494
5495 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5496 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5497 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005498 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005499 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5500 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5501 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5502 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5503
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005504 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005505 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005506 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005507
5508 Arguments:
5509 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5510 named "server-state-file".
5511
5512 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5513 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5514 name is used as a file name.
5515
5516 none don't load any stat for this backend
5517
5518 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005519 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5520 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5521 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005522 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005523 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005524
5525 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5526 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5527
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005528 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005529
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005530 global
5531 stats socket /tmp/socket
5532 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005533
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005534 defaults
5535 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005536
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005537 backend bk
5538 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5539 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005540
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005541
5542 Then one can run :
5543
5544 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5545
5546 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5547
5548 1
5549 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5550 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5551 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5552
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005553 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005554
5555 global
5556 stats socket /tmp/socket
5557 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5558
5559 defaults
5560 load-server-state-from-file local
5561
5562 backend bk
5563 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5564 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5565
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005566
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005567 Then one can run :
5568
5569 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5570
5571 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5572
5573 1
5574 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5575 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5576 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5577
5578 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5579 "show servers state"
5580
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005581
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005582log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005583log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5584 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005585no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005586 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5588 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005589
5590 Prefix :
5591 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5592 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5593 prefix does not allow arguments.
5594
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005595 Arguments :
5596 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5597 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5598 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5599 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5600 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5601 parameter.
5602
5603 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5604 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5605
5606 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5607 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5608 standard syslog port).
5609
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005610 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5611 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5612 standard syslog port).
5613
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005614 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5615 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5616 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005617 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005618
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005619 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5620 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5621 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5622 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5623 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5624 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5625 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5626 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5627 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5628 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5629 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5630 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5631 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5632 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5633 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5634 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005635 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5636 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005637
5638 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5639 and "fd@2", see above.
5640
5641 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5642 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005643
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005644 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5645 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5646 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5647 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5648 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5649 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5650 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5651 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5652 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5653 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005654 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005655
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005656 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5657 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5658 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5659 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5660 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5661
5662 <sample_size>
5663 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5664 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5665 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5666 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5667 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5668
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005669 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5670 one of the following :
5671
5672 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5673 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5674
5675 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5676 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5677
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005678 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5679 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5680 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5681 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5682 systemd logger consumes.
5683
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005684 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5685 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5686 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5687 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5688
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005689 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5690
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005691 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5692 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5693 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5694
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005695 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5696 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5697 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5698 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005699
5700 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5701 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5702 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005703 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5704 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5705 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5706 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5707 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005708
5709 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5710
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005711 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5712 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5713 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005714
5715 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5716 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5717 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5718 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5719
5720 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5721 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005722
5723 Example :
5724 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005725 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5726 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5727 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005728 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5729 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005730 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005731
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005732
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005733log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005734 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5735 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5736 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005737
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005738 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5739 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5740 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5741 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5742 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005743
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005744 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5745 "option httplog" directives.
5746
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005747log-format-sd <string>
5748 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5749 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5750 yes | yes | yes | no
5751
5752 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5753 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5754 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5755 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5756 which covers the log format string in depth.
5757
5758 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5759 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5760
5761 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5762 log format to "rfc5424".
5763
5764 Example :
5765 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5766
5767
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005768log-tag <string>
5769 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5770 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5771 yes | yes | yes | yes
5772
5773 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5774 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5775 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5776 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5777 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5778 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5779 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5780 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5781 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005782
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005783max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5784 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5785 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5786 yes | no | yes | yes
5787
5788 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5789 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5790 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5791 servers.
5792
5793 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5794 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5795 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5796 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5797 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005798 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005799 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5800 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5801 picking a different server.
5802
5803 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5804 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5805 even if they have to be queued.
5806
5807 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5808 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5809
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005810max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5811 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5812 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5813 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005814
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005815maxconn <conns>
5816 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5818 yes | yes | yes | no
5819 Arguments :
5820 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5821 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5822 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5823 closes.
5824
5825 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5826 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5827 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5828 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005829 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5830 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5831 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5832 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005833
5834 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5835 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5836 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5837
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005838 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5839 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005840
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005841 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5842
5843
5844mode { tcp|http|health }
5845 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5847 yes | yes | yes | yes
5848 Arguments :
5849 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5850 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5851 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5852 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5853
5854 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5855 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5856 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5857 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5858 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5859
5860 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005861 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5862 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5863 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5864 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5865 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5866 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5867 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005868
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005869 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5870 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5871 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005872
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005873 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005874 defaults http_instances
5875 mode http
5876
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005877 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005878
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005879
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005880monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005881 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5883 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005884 Arguments :
5885 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5886 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005887 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005888 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5889 backend and its backup.
5890
5891 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5892 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5893 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5894 servers in a list of backends.
5895
5896 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5897 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5898 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5899 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5900 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5901 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5902 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005903 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5904 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005905
5906 Example:
5907 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005908 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005909 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5910 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5911 monitor-uri /site_alive
5912 monitor fail if site_dead
5913
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005914 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005915
5916
5917monitor-net <source>
5918 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5920 yes | yes | yes | no
5921 Arguments :
5922 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5923 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5924 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5925 followed by a mask.
5926
5927 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5928 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005929 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005930 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5931
5932 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5933 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5934 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5935 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005936 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5937 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5938 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005939
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005940 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5941 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5942 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5943 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5944 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5945 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005946
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005947 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5948 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005949
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005950 Example :
5951 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5952 frontend www
5953 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5954
5955 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5956
5957
5958monitor-uri <uri>
5959 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5961 yes | yes | yes | no
5962 Arguments :
5963 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5964 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5965
5966 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5967 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5968 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5969 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5970 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5971 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5972 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5973 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5974
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005975 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5976 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5977 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5978 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5979 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5980 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5981 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5982 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005983
5984 Example :
5985 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5986 frontend www
5987 mode http
5988 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5989
5990 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005992
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005993option abortonclose
5994no option abortonclose
5995 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5997 yes | no | yes | yes
5998 Arguments : none
5999
6000 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6001 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6002 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6003 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006004 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006005 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6006 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6007 encountered while delivering the response.
6008
6009 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6010 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6011 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6012 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6013 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6014 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006015 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006016 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006017 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006018 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6019 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6020 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6021
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006022 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6023 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006024 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6025 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6026 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6027 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6028 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6029 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006030 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006031
6032 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6033 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6034
6035 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6036
6037
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006038option accept-invalid-http-request
6039no option accept-invalid-http-request
6040 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6042 yes | yes | yes | no
6043 Arguments : none
6044
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006045 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006046 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006047 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006048 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6049 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6050 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6051 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6052 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006053 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6054 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6055 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6056 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006057 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006058 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006059 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6060 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6061 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006062
6063 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6064 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6065 been confirmed.
6066
6067 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6068 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006069 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6070 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006071 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6072
6073 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6074 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6075
6076 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6077 stats socket.
6078
6079
6080option accept-invalid-http-response
6081no option accept-invalid-http-response
6082 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6084 yes | no | yes | yes
6085 Arguments : none
6086
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006087 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006088 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006089 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006090 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6091 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6092 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6093 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6094 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006095 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6096 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6097 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006098
6099 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6100 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6101 been confirmed.
6102
6103 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6104 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6105 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6106 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6107
6108 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6109 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6110
6111 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6112 stats socket.
6113
6114
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006115option allbackups
6116no option allbackups
6117 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6119 yes | no | yes | yes
6120 Arguments : none
6121
6122 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6123 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6124 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6125 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6126 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6127 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6128 order between the backup servers anymore.
6129
6130 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6131 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6132
6133 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6134 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6135
6136
6137option checkcache
6138no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006139 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6141 yes | no | yes | yes
6142 Arguments : none
6143
6144 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6145 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006146 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006147 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6148 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006149 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006150
6151 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006152 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006153 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006154 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6155 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006156 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006157 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006158 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6159 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006160 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006161 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6162 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006163 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006164 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6165 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6166 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6167 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6168 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6169 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6170 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6171 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6172 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6173
6174 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006175 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006176 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006177 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006178 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
6179
6180 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6181 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006182 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006183 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006184
6185 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6186 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6187
6188
6189option clitcpka
6190no option clitcpka
6191 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6193 yes | yes | yes | no
6194 Arguments : none
6195
6196 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6197 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006198 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006199 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6200
6201 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6202 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6203 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6204 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6205
6206 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6207 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6208 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6209 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6210 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6211
6212 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6213
6214 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6215 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6216 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6217
6218 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6219 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6220
6221 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6222
6223
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006224option contstats
6225 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6227 yes | yes | yes | no
6228 Arguments : none
6229
6230 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6231 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6232 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6233 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006234 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6235 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6236 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6237 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6238 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006239
6240
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006241option dontlog-normal
6242no option dontlog-normal
6243 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6245 yes | yes | yes | no
6246 Arguments : none
6247
6248 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6249 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6250 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6251 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6252 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6253 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6254 logged.
6255
6256 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6257 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6258 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006260 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006261 logging.
6262
6263
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006264option dontlognull
6265no option dontlognull
6266 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6268 yes | yes | yes | no
6269 Arguments : none
6270
6271 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6272 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6273 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6274 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6275 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6276 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006277 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6278 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6279 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006280
6281 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006282 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006283 would not be logged.
6284
6285 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6286 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6287
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006288 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6289 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006290
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006291
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006292option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006293 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6295 yes | yes | yes | yes
6296 Arguments :
6297 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6298 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006299 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006300 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006301
6302 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6303 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6304 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6305 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6306 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6307 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6308 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006309 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6310 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6311 possible that the client has already brought one.
6312
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006313 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006314 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006315 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006316 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006317 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006318 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006319
6320 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6321 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6322 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6323 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6324 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6325 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6326 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6327
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006328 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6329 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6330 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6331 are under the control of the end-user.
6332
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006333 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006334 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6335 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006336 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6337 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6338 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006339
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006340 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006341 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6342 frontend www
6343 mode http
6344 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6345
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006346 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6347 backend www
6348 mode http
6349 option forwardfor header X-Client
6350
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006351 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006352 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006353
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006354
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006355option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6356no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6357 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6359 yes | yes | yes | no
6360 Arguments : none
6361
6362 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6363 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6364 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6365 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6366 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6367 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6368 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6369
6370 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6371 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6372 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6373 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6374 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6375 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6376 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6377 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6378 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6379 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6380
6381 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6382
6383 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6384 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6385
6386 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6387 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6388
6389
6390option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6391no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6392 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6394 yes | no | yes | yes
6395 Arguments : none
6396
6397 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6398 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6399 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6400 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6401 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6402 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6403 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6404
6405 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6406 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6407 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6408 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6409 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6410 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6411 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6412 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6413 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6414 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6415
6416 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6417
6418 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6419 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6420
6421 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6422 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6423
6424
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006425option http-buffer-request
6426no option http-buffer-request
6427 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6429 yes | yes | yes | yes
6430 Arguments : none
6431
6432 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6433 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6434 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6435 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6436 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6437 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6438 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6439 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006440 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006441 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6442 default.
6443
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006444 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006445
6446
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006447option http-ignore-probes
6448no option http-ignore-probes
6449 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6451 yes | yes | yes | no
6452 Arguments : none
6453
6454 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6455 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6456 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6457 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6458 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6459 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6460 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6461 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6462 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006463 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6464 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006465 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6466
6467 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6468 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6469 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6470 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6471 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6472 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6473 are often the only way to detect them.
6474
6475 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6476 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6477
6478 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6479
6480
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006481option http-keep-alive
6482no option http-keep-alive
6483 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6485 yes | yes | yes | yes
6486 Arguments : none
6487
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006488 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6489 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006490 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6491 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6492 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6493 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6494 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006495
6496 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6497 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006498 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6499 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6500 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6501 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6502 situations where this option may be useful :
6503
6504 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006505 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006506
6507 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6508 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6509
6510 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6511 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6512 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6513 request.
6514
6515 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6516 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006517 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6518 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6519 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006520
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006521 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6522 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6523 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6524 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6525 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6526 not set.
6527
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006528 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006529 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6530 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006531
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006532 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006533 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006534 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006535
6536
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006537option http-no-delay
6538no option http-no-delay
6539 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6541 yes | yes | yes | yes
6542 Arguments : none
6543
6544 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6545 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6546 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6547 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6548 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6549 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6550 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6551 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6552 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6553 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6554 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6555 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6556 affected.
6557
6558 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6559 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6560 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6561 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6562 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6563 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6564 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6565 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6566 latency environments.
6567
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006568 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6569
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006570
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006571option http-pretend-keepalive
6572no option http-pretend-keepalive
6573 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006575 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006576 Arguments : none
6577
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006578 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006579 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6580 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6581 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6582 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6583 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6584 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6585 consider the response complete.
6586
6587 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6588 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6589 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6590 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006591 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006592 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6593
6594 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6595 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6596 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6597 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6598 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6599 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6600 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6601
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006602 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6603 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6604 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6605 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6606 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6607 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006608
6609 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6610 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6611
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006612 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006613 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006614
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006615
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006616option http-server-close
6617no option http-server-close
6618 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6620 yes | yes | yes | yes
6621 Arguments : none
6622
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006623 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6624 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6625 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6626 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006627 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6628 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6629 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6630 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6631 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6632 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6633 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6634 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6635 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6636 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6637 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006638
6639 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6640 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6641 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6642 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006643 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6644 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006645
6646 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6647 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006648 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6649 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6650 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006651
6652 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6653 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6654
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006655 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6656 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006657
6658
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006659option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6660no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6661 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006663 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006664 Arguments : none
6665
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006666 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6667 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6668 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6669
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006670 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6671 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6672 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6673 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006674 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006675
6676 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006677 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006678 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6679 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6680 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6681 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6682 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6683 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6684 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006685
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006686 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6687 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6688 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6689 backend.
6690
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006691 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6692 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6693
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006694 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6695 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006696
6697
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006698option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006699no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006700 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6702 yes | yes | yes | no
6703 Arguments : none
6704
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006705 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006706 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6707 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6708 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6709 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6710 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6711 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6712
6713 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6714 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006715 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6716 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6717 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006718
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006719 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6720 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6721 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6722 front of an existing proxy.
6723
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006724 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6725
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006726 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006727
6728
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006729option http-use-htx
6730no option http-use-htx
6731 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6733 yes | yes | yes | yes
6734 Arguments : none
6735
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006736 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006737 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006738 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6739 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6740 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6741 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6742 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006743
6744 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6745 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6746 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6747 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006748 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6749 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6750 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6751 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006752
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006753 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6754 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6755 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6756 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6757 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006758
6759 See also : "mode http"
6760
6761
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006762option httpchk
6763option httpchk <uri>
6764option httpchk <method> <uri>
6765option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6766 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6768 yes | no | yes | yes
6769 Arguments :
6770 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6771 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6772 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6773 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6774 ones.
6775
6776 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6777 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6778 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6779
6780 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6781 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6782 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006783 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006784
6785 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6786 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6787 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6788 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6789 the lack of any response.
6790
6791 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6792
6793 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6794 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6795 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6796
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006797 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
6798 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
6799 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
6800 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
6801
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006802 Examples :
6803 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6804 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6805 backend https_relay
6806 mode tcp
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006807 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
6808 http-check send hdr Host www
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006809 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6810
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006811 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6812 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6813 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006814
6815
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006816option httpclose
6817no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006818 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6820 yes | yes | yes | yes
6821 Arguments : none
6822
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006823 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6824 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6825 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6826 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006827 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006828
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006829 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6830 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006831 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006832 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6833 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006834
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006835 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6836 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6837 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006838
6839 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6840 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006841 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006842 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6843 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6844 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006845
6846 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6847 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6848
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006849 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006850
6851
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006852option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006853 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006855 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006856 Arguments :
6857 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6858 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6859 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006860 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006861 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006862
6863 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6864 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6865 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6866 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6867 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6868 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6869 ports.
6870
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006871 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6872 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006873
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006874 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6875
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006876 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006877
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006878
6879option http_proxy
6880no option http_proxy
6881 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6883 yes | yes | yes | yes
6884 Arguments : none
6885
6886 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6887 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6888 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6889 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6890 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6891
6892 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6893 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006894 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6895 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006896
6897 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6898 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6899
6900 Example :
6901 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6902 backend direct_forward
6903 option httpclose
6904 option http_proxy
6905
6906 See also : "option httpclose"
6907
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006908
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006909option independent-streams
6910no option independent-streams
6911 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6913 yes | yes | yes | yes
6914 Arguments : none
6915
6916 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6917 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6918 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6919 receive data or not.
6920
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006921 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006922 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6923 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6924 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6925 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6926 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6927 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6928 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6929 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6930 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6931 socket buffers.
6932
6933 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6934 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6935 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6936 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6937 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6938
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006939 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006940 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6941 deprecated.
6942
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006943 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006944
6945
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006946option ldap-check
6947 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6949 yes | no | yes | yes
6950 Arguments : none
6951
6952 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6953 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6954 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6955 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6956
6957 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6958 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6959
6960 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6961 configure it.
6962
6963 Example :
6964 option ldap-check
6965
6966 See also : "option httpchk"
6967
6968
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006969option external-check
6970 Use external processes for server health checks
6971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6972 yes | no | yes | yes
6973
6974 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6975 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6976 command".
6977
6978 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6979
6980 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6981
6982
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006983option log-health-checks
6984no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006985 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6987 yes | no | yes | yes
6988 Arguments : none
6989
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006990 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6991 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6992 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006993
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006994 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6995 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6996 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6997 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6998 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6999
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007000 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007001 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007002
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007003 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7004 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7005 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007006
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007007
7008option log-separate-errors
7009no option log-separate-errors
7010 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7012 yes | yes | yes | no
7013 Arguments : none
7014
7015 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7016 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7017 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7018 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7019 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7020 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7021 provides very important information.
7022
7023 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7024 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7025 error logs.
7026
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007027 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007028 logging.
7029
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007030
7031option logasap
7032no option logasap
Jerome Magnina1d4a732020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007033 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7035 yes | yes | yes | no
7036 Arguments : none
7037
Jerome Magnina1d4a732020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007038 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7039 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7040 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7041 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7042
7043 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7044 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7045 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7046 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7047 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
7048 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transfered
7049 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7050 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7051 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7052 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
7053 transfered.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007054
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007055 Examples :
7056 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7057 mode http
7058 option httplog
7059 option logasap
7060 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7061
7062 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7063 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7064 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7065 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007067 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007068 logging.
7069
7070
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007071option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007072 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7074 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007075 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007076 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7077 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007078 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007079
7080 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7081 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007082 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007083 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7084 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7085 in the MySQL table, like this :
7086
7087 USE mysql;
7088 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7089 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7090
7091 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007092 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007093 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7094 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7095 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7096 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7097 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7098 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7099 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7100
7101 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7102 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007103
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007104 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007105
7106 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7107 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7108 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7109 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007110 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7111 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007112
7113 See also: "option httpchk"
7114
7115
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007116option nolinger
7117no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007118 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007119 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7120 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007121 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007122
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007123 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007124 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7125 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7126 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7127 connections.
7128
7129 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7130 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7131 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7132 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7133 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7134 this too.
7135
7136 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7137 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7138 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7139
7140 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7141 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7142 for servers.
7143
7144 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7145 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7146
7147
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007148option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7149 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7151 yes | yes | yes | yes
7152 Arguments :
7153 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7154 matching <network>
7155 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7156 header name.
7157
7158 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7159 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7160 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7161 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7162 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7163 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7164 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7165 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7166 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7167 possible that the client has already brought one.
7168
7169 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7170 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7171 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7172 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7173 header and requires different one.
7174
7175 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7176 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7177 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7178 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7179 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7180 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7181 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7182
7183 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7184 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7185 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7186 both are defined.
7187
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007188 Examples :
7189 # Original Destination address
7190 frontend www
7191 mode http
7192 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7193
7194 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7195 backend www
7196 mode http
7197 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7198
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007199 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007200
7201
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007202option persist
7203no option persist
7204 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7205 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7206 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007207 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007208
7209 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7210 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7211 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7212 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7213 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7214 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7215 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7216 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7217 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7218 redirected to another valid server.
7219
7220 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7221 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7222
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007223 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007224
7225
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007226option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7227 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7229 yes | no | yes | yes
7230 Arguments :
7231 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7232 PostgreSQL server.
7233
7234 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7235 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7236 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7237 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7238
7239 See also: "option httpchk"
7240
7241
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007242option prefer-last-server
7243no option prefer-last-server
7244 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7245 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7246 yes | no | yes | yes
7247 Arguments : none
7248
7249 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7250 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7251 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7252 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7253 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7254 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7255 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7256 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7257 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007258 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7259 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007260 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7261 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7262 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007263 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7264 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7265 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007266
7267 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7268 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7269
7270 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7271
7272
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007273option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007274option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007275no option redispatch
7276 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7277 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7278 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007279 Arguments :
7280 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7281 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7282 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007283 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007284 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007285 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007286 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7287 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7288 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7289
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007290
7291 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7292 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7293 be able to access the service anymore.
7294
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007295 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7296 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007297
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007298 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007299 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7300 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007302 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
7303 "redisp" keywords.
7304
7305 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7306 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7307
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007308 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007309
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007310
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007311option redis-check
7312 Use redis health checks for server testing
7313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7314 yes | no | yes | yes
7315 Arguments : none
7316
7317 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7318 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7319 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7320 find the "+PONG" response message.
7321
7322 Example :
7323 option redis-check
7324
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007325 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007326
7327
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007328option smtpchk
7329option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7330 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7332 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007333 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007334 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007335 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007336 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7337
7338 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7339 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7340 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7341
7342 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7343 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7344 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7345 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7346 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7347 dead server.
7348
7349 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7350 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007351 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007352 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7353
7354 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7355 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7356 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7357 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007358 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007359
7360 Example :
7361 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7362
7363 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007365
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007366option socket-stats
7367no option socket-stats
7368
7369 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7371 yes | yes | yes | no
7372
7373 Arguments : none
7374
7375
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007376option splice-auto
7377no option splice-auto
7378 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7380 yes | yes | yes | yes
7381 Arguments : none
7382
7383 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7384 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007385 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007386 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007387 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007388 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7389 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7390 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7391 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7392
7393 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7394 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7395 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7396 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7397 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7398 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7399 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7400 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7401 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7402 keyword.
7403
7404 Example :
7405 option splice-auto
7406
7407 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7408 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7409
7410 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7411 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7412
7413
7414option splice-request
7415no option splice-request
7416 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7418 yes | yes | yes | yes
7419 Arguments : none
7420
7421 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007422 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007423 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7424 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7425 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7426 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7427
7428 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7429
7430 Example :
7431 option splice-request
7432
7433 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7434 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7435
7436 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7437 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7438
7439
7440option splice-response
7441no option splice-response
7442 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7444 yes | yes | yes | yes
7445 Arguments : none
7446
7447 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007448 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007449 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7450 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7451 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7452 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7453
7454 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7455
7456 Example :
7457 option splice-response
7458
7459 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7460 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7461
7462 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7463 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7464
7465
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007466option spop-check
7467 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7469 no | no | no | yes
7470 Arguments : none
7471
7472 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7473 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7474 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7475 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7476
7477 Example :
7478 option spop-check
7479
7480 See also : "option httpchk"
7481
7482
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007483option srvtcpka
7484no option srvtcpka
7485 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7487 yes | no | yes | yes
7488 Arguments : none
7489
7490 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7491 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007492 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007493 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7494
7495 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7496 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7497 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7498 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7499
7500 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7501 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7502 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7503 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7504 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7505
7506 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7507
7508 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7509 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7510 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7511
7512 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7513 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7514
7515 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7516
7517
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007518option ssl-hello-chk
7519 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7521 yes | no | yes | yes
7522 Arguments : none
7523
7524 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7525 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7526 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7527 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7528 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7529 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7530 hello message.
7531
7532 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7533 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7534 messages, which is appreciable.
7535
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007536 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7537 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7538 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007539
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007540 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7541
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007542
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007543option tcp-check
7544 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7545 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7546 yes | no | yes | yes
7547
7548 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7549 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7550
7551 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7552 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7553 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7554
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007555 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007556 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7557 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7558 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7559 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7560 only.
7561
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007562 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007563 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7564 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7565 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7566 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7567
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007568 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007569 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7570 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007571 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007572 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7573 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7574 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7575 the respective protocols.
7576 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007577 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007578
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007579 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7580 script.
7581
7582 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7583 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7584 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7585 The "comment" is of course optional.
7586
7587
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007588 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007589 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007590 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007591 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007592
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007593 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007594 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007595 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007596
7597 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7598 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007599 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007600 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007601 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007602 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007603 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007604 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007605 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7606 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007607 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007608 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7609 tcp-check expect string +OK
7610
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007611 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007612 (send many headers before analyzing)
7613 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007614 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007615 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7616 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7617 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7618 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007619 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007620
7621
7622 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7623
7624
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007625option tcp-smart-accept
7626no option tcp-smart-accept
7627 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7629 yes | yes | yes | no
7630 Arguments : none
7631
7632 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7633 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7634 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7635 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7636 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7637 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7638
7639 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7640 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7641 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7642 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7643
7644 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7645 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7646 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007647 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007648
7649 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7650 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7651 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7652
7653 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7654 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7655 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7656
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007657 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7658
7659
7660option tcp-smart-connect
7661no option tcp-smart-connect
7662 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7664 yes | no | yes | yes
7665 Arguments : none
7666
7667 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7668 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7669 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7670 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7671 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7672
7673 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7674 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7675 complex.
7676
7677 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7678 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7679 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7680
7681 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7682 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7683
7684 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7685
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007686
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007687option tcpka
7688 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7690 yes | yes | yes | yes
7691 Arguments : none
7692
7693 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7694 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007695 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007696 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7697
7698 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7699 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7700 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7701 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7702
7703 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7704 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7705 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7706 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7707 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7708
7709 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7710
7711 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7712 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7713 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7714 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7715 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7716 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7717 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7718 backends.
7719
7720 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7721
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007722
7723option tcplog
7724 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007726 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007727 Arguments : none
7728
7729 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7730 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7731 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7732 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7733 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7734 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7735 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7736 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7737
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007738 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7739
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007740 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007741
7742
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007743option transparent
7744no option transparent
7745 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007747 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007748 Arguments : none
7749
7750 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7751 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7752 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7753 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7754 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7755 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7756 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7757 appropriate server.
7758
7759 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7760 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7761
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007762 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007763 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007764
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007765
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007766external-check command <command>
7767 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7769 yes | no | yes | yes
7770
7771 Arguments :
7772 <command> is the external command to run
7773
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007774 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7775
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007776 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007777
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007778 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7779 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7780 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7781 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7782 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7783 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007784
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007785 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7786
7787 Environment variables :
7788 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7789 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7790
7791 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7792
7793 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7794
7795 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7796 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7797 for a UNIX socket).
7798
7799 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7800
7801 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7802
7803 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7804
7805 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7806
7807 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7808
7809 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7810 socket).
7811
7812 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7813 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7814
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007815 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7816
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007817 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7818 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7819 failed.
7820
7821 Example :
7822 external-check command /bin/true
7823
7824 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7825
7826
7827external-check path <path>
7828 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7830 yes | no | yes | yes
7831
7832 Arguments :
7833 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7834
7835 The default path is "".
7836
7837 Example :
7838 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7839
7840 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7841 "external-check command"
7842
7843
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007844persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007845persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007846 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7848 yes | no | yes | yes
7849 Arguments :
7850 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007851 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7852 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007853
7854 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7855 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007856 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007857 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7858 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7859 forwarded to this server.
7860
7861 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7862 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7863 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007864 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007865 a single "listen" section.
7866
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007867 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7868 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7869 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7870
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007871 Example :
7872 listen tse-farm
7873 bind :3389
7874 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7875 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7876 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7877 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7878 persist rdp-cookie
7879 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007880 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007881 balance rdp-cookie
7882 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7883 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7884
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007885 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7886 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007887
7888
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007889rate-limit sessions <rate>
7890 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7892 yes | yes | yes | no
7893 Arguments :
7894 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7895 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7896
7897 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7898 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7899 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7900 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7901 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7902 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7903
7904 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7905 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7906 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7907 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7908
7909 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7910 listen smtp
7911 mode tcp
7912 bind :25
7913 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007914 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007915
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007916 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7917 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7918 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007919
7920 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7921
7922
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007923redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7924redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7925redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007926 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7928 no | yes | yes | yes
7929
7930 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007931 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007932
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007933 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007934 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007935 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7936 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7937 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007938
7939 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7940 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7941 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7942 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7943 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007944 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7945 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7946 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7947 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007948
7949 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7950 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7951 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7952 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7953 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7954 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007955 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007956 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007957 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7958 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7959 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007960
7961 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007962 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7963 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7964 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007965 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007966 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7967 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7968 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7969 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007970
7971 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007972 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007973
7974 - "drop-query"
7975 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7976 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7977 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7978 with a location-type redirect.
7979
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007980 - "append-slash"
7981 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7982 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7983 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7984 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7985
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007986 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7987 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7988 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7989 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7990 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7991 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7992 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7993
7994 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7995 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7996 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7997 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7998 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7999 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8000 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008001
8002 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8003 acl clear dst_port 80
8004 acl secure dst_port 8080
8005 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008006 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008007 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008008 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8009
8010 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008011 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8012 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8013 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008014 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008015
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008016 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8017 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8018 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8019
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008020 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008021 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008022
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008023 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008024 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8025 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8026 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008027
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008028 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008029
8030
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008031redisp (deprecated)
8032redispatch (deprecated)
8033 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8034 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8035 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008036 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008037
8038 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8039 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8040 be able to access the service anymore.
8041
8042 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
8043 redistribute them to a working server.
8044
8045 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
8046 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8047 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008049 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
8050 "option redispatch" instead.
8051
8052 See also : "option redispatch"
8053
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008054
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008055reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008056 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
8057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8058 no | yes | yes | yes
8059 Arguments :
8060 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8061 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008062 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008063
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01008064 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8065 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8066
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008067 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8068 the last header of an HTTP request.
8069
8070 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8071 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8072 responses.
8073
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01008074 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
8075 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
8076 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
8077
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008078 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
8079 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008080
8081
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008082reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8083reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008084 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8086 no | yes | yes | yes
8087 Arguments :
8088 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8089 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8090 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8091 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8092 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8093 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
8094 ignores case.
8095
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008096 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8097 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8098
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008099 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8100 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
8101 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8102 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008103 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008104
8105 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8106 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8107
8108 Example :
8109 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
8110 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8111 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8112
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008113 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
8114 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008115
8116
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008117reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8118reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008119 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
8120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8121 no | yes | yes | yes
8122 Arguments :
8123 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8124 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8125 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8126 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8127 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
8128 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
8129
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008130 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8131 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8132
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008133 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
8134 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
8135 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
8136 next servers.
8137
8138 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8139 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8140 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8141
8142 Example :
8143 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
8144 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
8145 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
8146
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008147 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
8148 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008149
8150
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008151reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8152reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008153 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8155 no | yes | yes | yes
8156 Arguments :
8157 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8158 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8159 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8160 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8161 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8162 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
8163 case.
8164
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008165 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8166 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8167
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008168 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8169 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
8170 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8171 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008172 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008173
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008174 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008175 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008176 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008177
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008178 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8179 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8180
8181 Example :
8182 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
8183 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8184 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8185
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008186 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8187 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008188
8189
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008190reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8191reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008192 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
8193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8194 no | yes | yes | yes
8195 Arguments :
8196 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8197 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8198 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8199 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8200 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8201 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
8202 case.
8203
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008204 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8205 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8206
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008207 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8208 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
8209 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
8210 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8211
8212 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8213 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8214
8215 Example :
8216 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
8217 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
8218 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8219 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8220
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008221 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8222 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008223
8224
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008225reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8226reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008227 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
8228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8229 no | yes | yes | yes
8230 Arguments :
8231 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8232 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8233 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8234 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8235 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
8236 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
8237
8238 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8239 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8240 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8241 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008242 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008243
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008244 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8245 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8246
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008247 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
8248 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
8249 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
8250
8251 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8252 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8253 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8254 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
8255 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8256
8257 Example :
8258 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008259 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008260 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
8261 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
8262
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008263 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
8264 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008265
8266
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008267reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8268reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008269 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
8270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8271 no | yes | yes | yes
8272 Arguments :
8273 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8274 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8275 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8276 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8277 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8278 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
8279 ignores case.
8280
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008281 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8282 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8283
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008284 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8285 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008286 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
8287 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
8288 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008289 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
8290 not set.
8291
8292 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
8293 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
8294 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
8295 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
8296 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
8297
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008298 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008299 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008300 # block all others.
8301 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
8302 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
8303
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008304 # block bad guys
8305 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
8306 reqitarpit . if badguys
8307
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008308 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
8309 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008310
8311
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008312retries <value>
8313 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8314 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8315 yes | no | yes | yes
8316 Arguments :
8317 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8318 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8319 default value is 3.
8320
8321 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8322 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8323 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8324
8325 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008326 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8327 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008328
8329 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8330 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8331
8332 See also : "option redispatch"
8333
8334
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008335retry-on [list of keywords]
8336 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8337 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8338 yes | no | yes | yes
8339 Arguments :
8340 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8341 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8342 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8343 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8344
8345 none never retry
8346
8347 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8348 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8349
8350 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8351 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8352 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8353 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8354 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8355 processing the request.
8356
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008357 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8358 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8359 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8360 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8361 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8362 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8363 overflow attack for example).
8364
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008365 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8366 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8367 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8368 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8369 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8370 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8371 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8372 amplify denial of service attacks.
8373
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008374 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8375 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8376 considered to be safe to retry.
8377
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008378 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8379 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8380 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8381 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8382
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008383 all-retryable-errors
8384 retry request for any error that are considered
8385 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8386 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8387 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8388
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008389 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8390 not cumulative.
8391
8392 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8393 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8394 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8395 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8396
8397 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8398 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8399 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8400 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8401 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8402 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8403 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8404 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8405 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8406 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8407 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8408 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8409
8410 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8411 should not use this directive.
8412
8413 The default is "conn-failure".
8414
8415 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8416
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008417rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008418 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8420 no | yes | yes | yes
8421 Arguments :
8422 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8423 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008424 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008425
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008426 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8427 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8428
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008429 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8430 the last header of an HTTP response.
8431
8432 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8433 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8434 responses.
8435
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008436 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8437 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008438
8439
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008440rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8441rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008442 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8444 no | yes | yes | yes
8445 Arguments :
8446 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8447 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8448 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8449 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8450 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8451 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8452 ignores case.
8453
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008454 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8455 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8456
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008457 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8458 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008459 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008460 client.
8461
8462 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8463 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8464 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8465
8466 Example :
8467 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008468 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008469
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008470 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8471 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008472
8473
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008474rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8475rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008476 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8478 no | yes | yes | yes
8479 Arguments :
8480 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8481 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8482 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8483 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8484 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8485 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8486 ignores case.
8487
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008488 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8489 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8490
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008491 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8492 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8493 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8494 case-sensitive.
8495
8496 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008497 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8498 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8499 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008500
8501 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8502 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8503
8504 Example :
8505 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8506 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8507
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008508 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8509 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008510
8511
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008512rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8513rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008514 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8516 no | yes | yes | yes
8517 Arguments :
8518 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8519 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8520 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8521 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8522 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8523 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8524 ignores case.
8525
8526 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8527 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8528 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8529 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008530 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008531
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008532 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8533 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8534
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008535 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8536 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8537 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8538
8539 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8540 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8541 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8542 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8543 are not case-sensitive.
8544
8545 Example :
8546 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8547 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8548
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008549 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8550 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008551
8552
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008553server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008554 Declare a server in a backend
8555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8556 no | no | yes | yes
8557 Arguments :
8558 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008559 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008560 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008561
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008562 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8563 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8564 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8565 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008566 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8567 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8568 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8569 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8570 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008571 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8572 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8573 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8574 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8575 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8576 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8577 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008578 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008579 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8580 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8581 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8582 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8583 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8584 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008585 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8586 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008587 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8588 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008589
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008590 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008591 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8592 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8593 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8594 adding this value to the client's port.
8595
8596 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8597 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008598 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008599
8600 Examples :
8601 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8602 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008603 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008604 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8605 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8606 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008607
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008608 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8609 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8610 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8611 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8612 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8613
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008614 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8615 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008616
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008617server-state-file-name [<file>]
8618 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8619 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8620 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8621 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8622 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8623 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8624
8625 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8626 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8627
8628 global
8629 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8630
Willy Tarreau750bb0c2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008631 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008632 load-server-state-from-file
8633
8634 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8635 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008636
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008637server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8638 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8639 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8641 no | no | yes | yes
8642
8643 Arguments:
8644 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8645
8646 <num | range>
8647 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8648 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8649 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8650 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8651
8652 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8653
8654 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8655
8656 <params*>
8657 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8658 keyword.
8659
8660 Examples:
8661 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8662 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8663 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8664
8665 # or
8666 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8667
8668 # would be equivalent to:
8669 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8670 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8671 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8672
8673
8674
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008675source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008676source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008677source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008678 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8680 yes | no | yes | yes
8681 Arguments :
8682 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8683 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008684
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008685 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008686 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8687 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8688 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8689 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8690 supported prefixes are :
8691 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8692 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8693 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008694 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008695 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8696 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008697
8698 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8699 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008700 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8701 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8702 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008703
8704 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8705 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8706 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8707 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8708 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8709 <addr>.
8710
8711 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8712 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8713 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8714 port.
8715
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008716 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8717 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8718 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8719 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008720 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008721 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8722 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8723 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8724 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8725 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8726 HTTP header.
8727
8728 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8729 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008730 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008731 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8732 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8733 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8734 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8735 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8736 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8737 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8738
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008739 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8740 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8741 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8742 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8743 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8744 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8745
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008746 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8747 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8748 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8749 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8750
8751 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8752 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8753 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8754 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8755 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8756 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8757
8758 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8759 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8760 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8761 there are two methods :
8762
8763 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8764 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8765 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8766 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8767 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8768 of the client ranges may be used.
8769
8770 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8771 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8772 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8773 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8774 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8775 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8776 same session.
8777
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008778 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8779 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8780 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008781 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008782
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008783 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8784
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008785 Examples :
8786 backend private
8787 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8788 source 192.168.1.200
8789
8790 backend transparent_ssl1
8791 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8792 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8793
8794 backend transparent_ssl2
8795 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8796 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8797 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8798
8799 backend transparent_ssl3
8800 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8801 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8802 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8803
8804 backend transparent_smtp
8805 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8806 # with Tproxy version 4.
8807 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8808
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008809 backend transparent_http
8810 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8811 # proxy.
8812 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8813
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008814 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008815 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008817
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008818srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8819 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8821 yes | no | yes | yes
8822 Arguments :
8823 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8824 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8825 as explained at the top of this document.
8826
8827 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8828 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8829 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8830 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8831 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8832 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8833 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8834
8835 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8836 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8837 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8838 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8839 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008840 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008841 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008842 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008843
8844 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8845 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8846 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8847 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8848 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8849 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8850
8851 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8852 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8853
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008854 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8855 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008856
8857
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008858stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8859 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008861 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008862
8863 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8864 matched.
8865
8866 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8867 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8868
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008869 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8870 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008871 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008872
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008873 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8874 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8875 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8876 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008877
8878 Example :
8879 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8880 backend stats_localhost
8881 stats enable
8882 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8883
8884 Example :
8885 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8886 backend stats_auth
8887 stats enable
8888 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8889 stats admin if TRUE
8890
8891 Example :
8892 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8893 userlist stats-auth
8894 group admin users admin
8895 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8896 group readonly users haproxy
8897 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8898
8899 backend stats_auth
8900 stats enable
8901 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8902 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8903 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8904 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8905
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008906 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8907 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8908 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008909
8910
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008911stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8912 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008914 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008915 Arguments :
8916 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8917
8918 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8919
8920 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8921 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8922 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8923 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8924 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8925 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8926
8927 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8928 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8929 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008930 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008931
8932 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8933 report using "stats scope".
8934
8935 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8936 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8937 unobvious parameters.
8938
8939 Example :
8940 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8941 backend public_www
8942 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8943 stats enable
8944 stats hide-version
8945 stats scope .
8946 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008947 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008948 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8949 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8950
8951 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8952 backend private_monitoring
8953 stats enable
8954 stats uri /admin?stats
8955 stats refresh 5s
8956
8957 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8958
8959
8960stats enable
8961 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008963 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008964 Arguments : none
8965
8966 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8967 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8968 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8969 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8970 - stats auth : no authentication
8971 - stats scope : no restriction
8972
8973 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8974 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8975 unobvious parameters.
8976
8977 Example :
8978 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8979 backend public_www
8980 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8981 stats enable
8982 stats hide-version
8983 stats scope .
8984 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008985 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008986 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8987 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8988
8989 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8990 backend private_monitoring
8991 stats enable
8992 stats uri /admin?stats
8993 stats refresh 5s
8994
8995 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8996
8997
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008998stats hide-version
8999 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009001 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009002 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009003
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009004 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9005 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9006 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9007 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9008 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9009 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009010
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009011 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9012 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9013 unobvious parameters.
9014
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009015 Example :
9016 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9017 backend public_www
9018 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009019 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009020 stats hide-version
9021 stats scope .
9022 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009023 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009024 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9025 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009026
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009027 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9028 backend private_monitoring
9029 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009030 stats uri /admin?stats
9031 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009032
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009033 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009034
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009035
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009036stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9037 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9038 Access control for statistics
9039
9040 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9041 no | no | yes | yes
9042
9043 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9044 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9045 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9046 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9047 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9048 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9049
9050 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9051 instance.
9052
9053 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9054 about ACL usage.
9055
9056
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009057stats realm <realm>
9058 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009060 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009061 Arguments :
9062 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9063 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9064 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9065
9066 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9067 using a backslash ('\').
9068
9069 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9070 only related to authentication.
9071
9072 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9073 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9074 unobvious parameters.
9075
9076 Example :
9077 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9078 backend public_www
9079 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9080 stats enable
9081 stats hide-version
9082 stats scope .
9083 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009084 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009085 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9086 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9087
9088 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9089 backend private_monitoring
9090 stats enable
9091 stats uri /admin?stats
9092 stats refresh 5s
9093
9094 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9095
9096
9097stats refresh <delay>
9098 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009100 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009101 Arguments :
9102 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9103 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9104 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9105 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9106 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9107 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9108
9109 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9110 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9111 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9112 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9113
9114 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9115 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9116 unobvious parameters.
9117
9118 Example :
9119 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9120 backend public_www
9121 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9122 stats enable
9123 stats hide-version
9124 stats scope .
9125 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009126 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009127 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9128 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9129
9130 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9131 backend private_monitoring
9132 stats enable
9133 stats uri /admin?stats
9134 stats refresh 5s
9135
9136 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9137
9138
9139stats scope { <name> | "." }
9140 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009142 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009143 Arguments :
9144 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9145 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9146 section in which the statement appears.
9147
9148 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9149 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9150 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9151 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9152 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9153 exists.
9154
9155 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9156 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9157 unobvious parameters.
9158
9159 Example :
9160 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9161 backend public_www
9162 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9163 stats enable
9164 stats hide-version
9165 stats scope .
9166 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009167 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009168 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9169 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9170
9171 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9172 backend private_monitoring
9173 stats enable
9174 stats uri /admin?stats
9175 stats refresh 5s
9176
9177 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9178
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009179
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009180stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009181 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009183 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009184
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009185 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009186 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9187
9188 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9189 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9190
9191 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9192 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009193 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009194
9195 Example :
9196 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9197 backend private_monitoring
9198 stats enable
9199 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9200 stats uri /admin?stats
9201 stats refresh 5s
9202
9203 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9204 global section.
9205
9206
9207stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009208 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9210 yes | yes | yes | yes
9211 Arguments : none
9212
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009213 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009214 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9215 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9216 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9217 - IP (socket, server)
9218 - cookie (backend, server)
9219
9220 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9221 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009222 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009223
9224 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9225
9226
9227stats show-node [ <name> ]
9228 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009230 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009231 Arguments:
9232 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9233 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9234
9235 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9236 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009237 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009238
9239 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9240 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9241 unobvious parameters.
9242
9243 Example:
9244 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9245 backend private_monitoring
9246 stats enable
9247 stats show-node Europe-1
9248 stats uri /admin?stats
9249 stats refresh 5s
9250
9251 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9252 section.
9253
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009254
9255stats uri <prefix>
9256 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009258 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009259 Arguments :
9260 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9261 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9262 query string.
9263
9264 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9265 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9266 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9267 possible to reach it in the application.
9268
9269 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009270 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009271 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9272 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9273 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9274 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9275
9276 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9277 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9278 an address or a port to statistics only.
9279
9280 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9281 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9282 unobvious parameters.
9283
9284 Example :
9285 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9286 backend public_www
9287 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9288 stats enable
9289 stats hide-version
9290 stats scope .
9291 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009292 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009293 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9294 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9295
9296 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9297 backend private_monitoring
9298 stats enable
9299 stats uri /admin?stats
9300 stats refresh 5s
9301
9302 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9303
9304
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009305stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9306 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009308 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009309
9310 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009311 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009312 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009313 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009314 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9315
9316 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9317 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9318 the "stick-table" statement.
9319
9320 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9321 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9322 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9323 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9324 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9325
9326 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9327 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9328 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9329 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9330 transformation rules.
9331
9332 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9333 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9334 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9335 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9336 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9337 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9338 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9339
9340 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9341 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9342 ACL based conditions.
9343
9344 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9345 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9346 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9347 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9348
9349 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9350 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9351 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9352 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9353
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009354 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9355 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009356 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009357
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009358 Example :
9359 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9360 # last 30 minutes
9361 backend pop
9362 mode tcp
9363 balance roundrobin
9364 stick store-request src
9365 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9366 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9367 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9368
9369 backend smtp
9370 mode tcp
9371 balance roundrobin
9372 stick match src table pop
9373 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9374 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9375
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009376 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009377 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009378
9379
9380stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9381 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9383 no | no | yes | yes
9384
9385 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9386 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9387 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9388 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9389
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009390 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9391 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009392 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009393
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009394 Examples :
9395 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009396 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009397
9398 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9399 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9400 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9401
9402
9403 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9404 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9405 backend http
9406 mode http
9407 balance roundrobin
9408 stick on src table https
9409 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9410 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9411 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9412
9413 backend https
9414 mode tcp
9415 balance roundrobin
9416 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9417 stick on src
9418 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9419 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9420
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009421 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009422
9423
9424stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9425 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9427 no | no | yes | yes
9428
9429 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009430 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009431 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009432 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009433 server is selected.
9434
9435 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9436 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9437 the "stick-table" statement.
9438
9439 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9440 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9441 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9442 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9443 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9444 address.
9445
9446 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9447 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9448 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9449 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9450 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9451 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9452 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9453 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9454 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9455 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9456
9457 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9458 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9459 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9460 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9461 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9462 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9463 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9464
9465 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9466 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9467 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9468 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9469
9470 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9471 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9472 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9473 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9474 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9475 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009476 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9477 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9478 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9479 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9480 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9481 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009482
9483 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9484 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9485 the request.
9486
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009487 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9488 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009489 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009490
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009491 Example :
9492 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9493 # last 30 minutes
9494 backend pop
9495 mode tcp
9496 balance roundrobin
9497 stick store-request src
9498 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9499 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9500 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9501
9502 backend smtp
9503 mode tcp
9504 balance roundrobin
9505 stick match src table pop
9506 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9507 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9508
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009509 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009510 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009511
9512
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009513stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009514 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9515 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009516 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009518 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009519
9520 Arguments :
9521 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9522 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9523 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9524 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9525
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009526 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9527 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9528 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9529 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9530
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009531 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9532 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9533 instance.
9534
9535 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9536 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9537 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9538 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9539 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9540 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009541 to 32 characters.
9542
9543 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9544 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9545 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009546 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009547 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9548 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009549
9550 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009551 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9552 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009553 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9554 increase.
9555
9556 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009557 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9558 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9559 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009560
9561 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9562 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9563 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9564 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009565 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009566 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9567 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9568 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9569 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9570 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9571 parameter (see below).
9572
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009573 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9574 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9575 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9576 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9577 soft restart.
9578
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009579 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9580 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009581
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009582 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9583 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9584 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9585 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009586 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009587 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009588 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9589 if not expiration delay is specified.
9590
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009591 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9592 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9593 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9594 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009595 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9596 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9597 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9598 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9599 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9600 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9601 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9602 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9603 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9604 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9605 types and their arguments.
9606
9607 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9608 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9609 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9610 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9611
9612 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9613 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9614 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009615 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009616
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009617 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9618 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9619 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009620 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009621 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009622 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009623
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009624 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9625 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9626 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9627 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9628
9629 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9630 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9631 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9632 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9633 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9634 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9635
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009636 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9637 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9638 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9639 they were received.
9640
9641 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9642 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9643 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9644 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9645 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9646
9647 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9648 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9649 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9650 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9651 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9652
9653 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9654 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9655 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9656
9657 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9658 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9659 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9660 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9661 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9662
9663 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9664 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9665 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9666 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9667 the client side.
9668
9669 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9670 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9671 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9672 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9673 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9674 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9675 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9676
9677 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9678 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9679 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9680 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9681 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9682 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009683 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009684
9685 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9686 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9687 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9688 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9689 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9690 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9691
9692 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009693 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009694 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9695 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9696
9697 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9698 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9699 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9700 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9701 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9702 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9703 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9704 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9705 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9706 recommended for better fairness.
9707
9708 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009709 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009710 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9711 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9712
9713 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9714 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9715 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9716 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9717 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9718 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9719 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9720 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9721 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9722 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009723
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009724 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9725 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009726 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9727 reference it.
9728
9729 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9730 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009731 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9732 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9733 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009734
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009735 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9736 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9737 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9738 something that can be ignored.
9739
9740 Example:
9741 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9742 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9743 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9744 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9745
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009746 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009747 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009748
9749
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009750stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009751 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9753 no | no | yes | yes
9754
9755 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009756 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009757 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009758 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009759 server is selected.
9760
9761 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9762 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9763 the "stick-table" statement.
9764
9765 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9766 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9767 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9768 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9769
9770 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9771 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9772 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9773 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9774 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9775 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009776 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009777 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9778 rules.
9779
9780 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9781 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9782 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9783 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9784 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9785 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9786 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9787
9788 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9789 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9790 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9791 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9792
9793 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9794 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9795 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9796 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9797 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9798 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009799 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9800 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9801 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9802 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9803 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9804 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9805 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9806 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9807 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009808
9809 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9810
9811 Example :
9812 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9813 backend https
9814 mode tcp
9815 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009816 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009817 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009818
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009819 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9820 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9821
9822 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9823 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9824 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9825
9826 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9827 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009828
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009829 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9830 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9831 # at offset 44.
9832
9833 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9834 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9835
9836 # Learn on response if server hello.
9837 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009838
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009839 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9840 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9841
9842 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9843 extraction.
9844
9845
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009846tcp-check connect [params*]
9847 Opens a new connection
9848 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9849 no | no | yes | yes
9850
9851 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9852 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9853 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9854
9855 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9856 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9857 of the sequence.
9858
9859 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9860 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9861 do.
9862
9863 Parameters :
9864 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9865 use the TCP connection.
9866
9867 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9868 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9869 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9870
9871 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9872
9873 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9874
9875 Examples:
9876 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9877 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9878 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9879 option tcp-check
9880 tcp-check connect
9881 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9882 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9883 tcp-check send \r\n
9884 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9885 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9886 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9887 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9888 tcp-check send \r\n
9889 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9890 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9891
9892 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9893 option tcp-check
9894 tcp-check connect port 110
9895 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9896 tcp-check connect port 143
9897 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9898 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9899
9900 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9901
9902
9903tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009904 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009905 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9906 no | no | yes | yes
9907
9908 Arguments :
9909 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9910 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9911 binary.
9912 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9913 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9914 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9915
9916 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9917 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9918 with the usual backslash ('\').
9919 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009920 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009921 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9922 used upper or lower case.
9923
9924
9925 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9926
9927 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9928 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9929 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9930 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9931 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9932 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9933 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9934 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9935
9936 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9937 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9938 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9939 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9940 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9941 expression.
9942
9943 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9944 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9945 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9946 this exact hexadecimal string.
9947 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9948
9949 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9950 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9951 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9952 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9953 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9954 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9955 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9956 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9957 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9958 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9959 the null character.
9960
9961 Examples :
9962 # perform a POP check
9963 option tcp-check
9964 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9965
9966 # perform an IMAP check
9967 option tcp-check
9968 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9969
9970 # look for the redis master server
9971 option tcp-check
9972 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009973 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009974 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9975 tcp-check expect string role:master
9976 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9977 tcp-check expect string +OK
9978
9979
9980 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9981 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9982
9983
9984tcp-check send <data>
9985 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9986 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9987 no | no | yes | yes
9988
9989 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9990 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9991
9992 Examples :
9993 # look for the redis master server
9994 option tcp-check
9995 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9996 tcp-check expect string role:master
9997
9998 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9999 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10000
10001
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010002tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
10003 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010004 tcp health check
10005 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10006 no | no | yes | yes
10007
10008 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10009 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010010 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010011 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
10012 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
10013 hexadecimal string.
10014 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
10015
10016 Examples :
10017 # redis check in binary
10018 option tcp-check
10019 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10020 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10021
10022
10023 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10024 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10025
10026
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010027tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10028 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10030 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010031 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010032 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10033 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010034
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010035 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010036
10037 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10038 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010039 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10040 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10041 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10042 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10043 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10044 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010045
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010046 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10047 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10048 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10049 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010050
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010051 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010052 - accept :
10053 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10054 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10055 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010056
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010057 - reject :
10058 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10059 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10060 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10061 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10062 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10063 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10064 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10065 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10066 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10067 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10068 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010069 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010070
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010071 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10072 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10073 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10074 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10075 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10076 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10077 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10078 hosts.
10079
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010080 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10081 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10082 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10083 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10084 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10085 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10086 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10087 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10088
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010089 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10090 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10091 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10092 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10093 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10094 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10095 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10096 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10097 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010098 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10099 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010100
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010101 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010102 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010103 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10104 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10105 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010106 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010107 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10108 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10109 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10110 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10111 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10112 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10113 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10114 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010115
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010116 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010117 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010118 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010119 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010120 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10121 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10122 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010123
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010124 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10125 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10126 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10127 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010128
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010129 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10130 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10131 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10132 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10133 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010134 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10135 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10136 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10137 layer7 information is extracted.
10138
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010139 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10140 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10141 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10142 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10143 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010144
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010145 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10146 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10147 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10148 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10149
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010150 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10151 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10152 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10153 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10154
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010155 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
10156 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10157 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10158 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10159 continues.
10160
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010161 - set-src <expr> :
10162 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10163 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10164 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010165 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010167 Arguments:
10168 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10169 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010170
10171 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010172 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10173
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010174 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10175 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010176
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010177 - set-src-port <expr> :
10178 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10179 expression.
10180
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010181 Arguments:
10182 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10183 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010184
10185 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010186 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10187
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010188 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10189 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10190 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010191
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010192 - set-dst <expr> :
10193 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10194 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10195 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10196 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10197 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10198
10199 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10200 followed by some converters.
10201
10202 Example:
10203
10204 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10205 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10206
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010207 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10208 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10209
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010210 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10211 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10212 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10213 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10214
10215
10216 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10217 followed by some converters.
10218
10219 Example:
10220
10221 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10222
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010223 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10224 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10225 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10226
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010227 - "silent-drop" :
10228 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010229 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010230 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10231 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10232 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10233 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10234 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010235 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10236 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010237 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10238 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010239 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010240 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10241 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10242 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10243 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10244
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010245 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10246 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10247 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010248
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010249 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10250 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10251 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010252
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010253 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010254 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010255 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010256
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010257 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10258 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10259 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010260
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010261 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010262 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10263 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010264
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010265 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10266
10267 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10268
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010269 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10270
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010271 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010272
10273
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010274tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10275 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010277 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010278 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010279 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10280 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010281
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010282 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010283
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010284 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010285 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10286 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10287 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10288 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010289
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010290 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10291 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10292 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10293 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010294 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10295 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10296 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10297 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10298 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10299 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010300 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010301 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010302
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010303 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10304 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10305 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10306 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010307
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010308 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010309 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010310 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010311 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10312 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010313 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010314 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010315 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010316 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +020010317 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010318 - set-dst <expr>
10319 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010320 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010321 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010322 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010323 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010324 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010325
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010326 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10327 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010328 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10329 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010330
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010331 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10332 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10333 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10334 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10335 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10336 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010337
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010338 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010339 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10340 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010341
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010342 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010343 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10344 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10345 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10346 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010347 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10348 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10349 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010350
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010351 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010352 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10353 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10354 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010355
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010356 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10357 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10358
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010359 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010360 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10361 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010362
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010363 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10364 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010365 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010366 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10367 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010368 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010369 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010370 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010371 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10372 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010373 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010374 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10375 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010376
10377 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10378 followed by some converters.
10379
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010380 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10381 <var-name>.
10382
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010383 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10384 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10385 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10386 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10387 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10388
10389 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10390 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10391 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10392 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10393 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10394 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10395 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10396 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10397 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10398 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10399 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10400
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010401 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10402 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10403 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10404 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10405 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10406
10407 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10408
10409 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10410
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010411 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10412 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10413 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10414 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10415 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10416 evaluated.
10417
10418 Example:
10419 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10420
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010421 Example:
10422
10423 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010424 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010425
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010426 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010427 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10428 # and reject everything else.
10429 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10430 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010431 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010432 tcp-request content reject
10433
10434 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010435 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10436 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10437 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010438 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010439
10440 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10441 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10442 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010443 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010444 tcp-request content reject
10445
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010446 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010447 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010448 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010449 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010450 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10451 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010452
10453 Example:
10454 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10455 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010456 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010457
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010458 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010459 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010460
10461 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010462 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010463 # protecting all our sites
10464 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010465 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10466 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010467 ...
10468 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10469
10470 backend http_dynamic
10471 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010472 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010473 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010474 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010475 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010476 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010477 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010478
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010479 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010480
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010481 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10482 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010483
10484
10485tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10486 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010488 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010489 Arguments :
10490 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10491 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10492 as explained at the top of this document.
10493
10494 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10495 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10496 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10497 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10498 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10499
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010500 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10501 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10502 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10503 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10504
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010505 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10506 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010507 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010508 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010509 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10510 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10511 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10512 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010513
10514 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10515 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10516 it pass through unaffected.
10517
10518 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10519 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10520 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010521 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010522 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10523 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010524 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10525 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10526 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010527
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010528 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010529 "timeout client".
10530
10531
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010532tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10533 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10535 no | no | yes | yes
10536 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010537 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10538 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010539
10540 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10541
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010542 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010543 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10544 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010545 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10546 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010547
10548 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10549
10550 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10551 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10552 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10553 inserted.
10554
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010555 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010556 - accept :
10557 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10558 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10559 the rules evaluation.
10560
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010561 - close :
10562 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10563 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10564 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10565 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10566 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10567 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010568 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010569 protocols.
10570
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010571 - reject :
10572 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10573 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010574 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010575
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010576 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10577 Sets a variable.
10578
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010579 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10580 Unsets a variable.
10581
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010582 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10583 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10584 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10585 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10586
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010587 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10588 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10589 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10590 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10591
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010592 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10593 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10594 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10595 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10596 continues.
10597
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010598 - "silent-drop" :
10599 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010600 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010601 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10602 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10603 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10604 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10605 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010606 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10607 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010608 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10609 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010610 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010611 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10612 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10613 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10614 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10615
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010616 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10617 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10618
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010619 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10620 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10621 for changing the default action to a reject.
10622
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010623 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10624 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10625 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10626 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010627 period.
10628
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010629 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10630 declared inline.
10631
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010632 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10633 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010634 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010635 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10636 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010637 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010638 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010639 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010640 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10641 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010642 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010643 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10644 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010645
10646 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10647 followed by some converters.
10648
10649 Example:
10650
10651 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10652
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010653 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10654 <var-name>.
10655
10656 Example:
10657
10658 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10659
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010660 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10661 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10662 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10663 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10664 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10665
10666 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10667
10668 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10669
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010670 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10671
10672 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10673
10674
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010675tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10676 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10678 no | yes | yes | no
10679 Arguments :
10680 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10681 below.
10682
10683 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10684
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010685 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010686 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10687 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10688 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10689 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10690 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10691 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10692 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010693 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010694 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10695 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10696 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10697 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10698 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10699 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10700 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10701 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10702 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10703 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10704 instead.
10705
10706 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10707 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10708 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10709 rules which may be inserted.
10710
10711 Several types of actions are supported :
10712 - accept : the request is accepted
10713 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10714 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10715 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010716 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010717 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10718 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010719 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010720 - silent-drop
10721
10722 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10723 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10724 sections for a complete description.
10725
10726 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10727 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10728 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10729
10730 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10731 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10732 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10733 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10734 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10735
10736 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10737 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10738
10739 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10740 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10741 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10742
10743 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10744 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10745 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10746
10747 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10748 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10749 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10750
10751 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10752 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10753 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10754
10755 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10756
10757 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10758
10759
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010760tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10761 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10763 no | no | yes | yes
10764 Arguments :
10765 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10766 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10767 as explained at the top of this document.
10768
10769 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10770
10771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010772timeout check <timeout>
10773 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10774 established.
10775
10776 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10777 yes | no | yes | yes
10778 Arguments:
10779 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10780 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10781 as explained at the top of this document.
10782
10783 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10784 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010785 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010786 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010787 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10788 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10789 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010790
10791 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10792 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10793
10794 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10795 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010796 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010797
10798 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10799 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10800 forget about it.
10801
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010802 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10803 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010804
10805
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010806timeout client <timeout>
10807timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10808 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10810 yes | yes | yes | no
10811 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010812 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010813 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10814 as explained at the top of this document.
10815
10816 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10817 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10818 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010819 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10820 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10821 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10822 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010823 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10824 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10825 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010826 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010827 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010828 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10829 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010830 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10831 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010832
10833 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10834 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10835 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10836 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010837 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010838 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10839
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010840 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010841
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010842 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10843 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10844 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10845
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010846 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10847 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010848
10849
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010850timeout client-fin <timeout>
10851 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10853 yes | yes | yes | no
10854 Arguments :
10855 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10856 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10857 as explained at the top of this document.
10858
10859 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10860 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10861 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10862 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10863 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10864 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10865 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010866 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10867 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10868 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010869
10870 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10871 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10872 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10873
10874 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10875
10876
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010877timeout connect <timeout>
10878timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10879 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10881 yes | no | yes | yes
10882 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010883 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010884 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10885 as explained at the top of this document.
10886
10887 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010888 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010889 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010890 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010891 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10892 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010893
10894 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10895 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10896 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10897 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010898 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010899 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10900
10901 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10902 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10903 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10904
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010905 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10906 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010907
10908
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010909timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10910 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10912 yes | yes | yes | yes
10913 Arguments :
10914 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10915 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10916 as explained at the top of this document.
10917
10918 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10919 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10920 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10921 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10922 once the request has started to present itself.
10923
10924 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10925 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10926 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10927 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10928 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10929
10930 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10931 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10932 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10933 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10934
10935 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10936 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010937 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010938 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10939 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010940 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010941
10942 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10943 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10944 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10945 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10946
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010947 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10948 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010949 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10950
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010951 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10952
10953
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010954timeout http-request <timeout>
10955 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010957 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010958 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010959 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010960 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10961 as explained at the top of this document.
10962
10963 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10964 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10965 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10966 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10967 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10968 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10969 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010970 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10971 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10972 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10973 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010974 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010975 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10976 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010977
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010978 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10979 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10980 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10981 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10982 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010983 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010984
10985 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10986 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010987 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010988 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10989 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10990
10991 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010992 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10993 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10994 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010995
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010996 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010997 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010998
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010999
11000timeout queue <timeout>
11001 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11003 yes | no | yes | yes
11004 Arguments :
11005 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11006 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11007 as explained at the top of this document.
11008
11009 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11010 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11011 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11012 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11013 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11014
11015 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11016 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11017 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11018 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11019
11020 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
11021
11022
11023timeout server <timeout>
11024timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
11025 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11027 yes | no | yes | yes
11028 Arguments :
11029 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11030 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11031 as explained at the top of this document.
11032
11033 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11034 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11035 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11036 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11037 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11038 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11039 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11040
11041 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11042 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11043 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11044 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11045 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011046 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011047 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011048 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11049 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011050 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11051 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011052
11053 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11054 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11055 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11056 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011057 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011058 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11059
11060 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
11061 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
11062 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
11063
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011064 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011065
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011066
11067timeout server-fin <timeout>
11068 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11070 yes | no | yes | yes
11071 Arguments :
11072 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11073 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11074 as explained at the top of this document.
11075
11076 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11077 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11078 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11079 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11080 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11081 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11082 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11083 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11084 situations, it should not be needed.
11085
11086 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11087 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11088 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11089
11090 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11091
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011092
11093timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011094 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11096 yes | yes | yes | yes
11097 Arguments :
11098 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11099 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11100 as explained at the top of this document.
11101
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011102 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
11103 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
11104 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
11105 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011106
11107 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11108 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11109 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11110 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011111 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011112
11113 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
11114
11115
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011116timeout tunnel <timeout>
11117 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11119 yes | no | yes | yes
11120 Arguments :
11121 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11122 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11123 as explained at the top of this document.
11124
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011125 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011126 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11127 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11128 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011129 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11130 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011131 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11132 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11133 specified.
11134
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011135 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11136 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11137 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11138 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11139 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11140 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11141 state.
11142
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011143 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11144 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11145 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11146 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011147 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011148
11149 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11150 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11151 forget about it.
11152
11153 Example :
11154 defaults http
11155 option http-server-close
11156 timeout connect 5s
11157 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011158 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011159 timeout server 30s
11160 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11161
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011162 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011163
11164
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011165transparent (deprecated)
11166 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011168 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011169 Arguments : none
11170
11171 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11172 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11173 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11174 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11175 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11176 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11177 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11178 appropriate server.
11179
11180 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11181
11182 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11183 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11184
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011185 See also: "option transparent"
11186
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011187unique-id-format <string>
11188 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11190 yes | yes | yes | no
11191 Arguments :
11192 <string> is a log-format string.
11193
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011194 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11195 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11196 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11197 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011198
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011199 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11200 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11201 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11202 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11203 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11204 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11205 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11206 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011207
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011208 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11209 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011210
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011211 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011212
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011213 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011214
11215 will generate:
11216
11217 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11218
11219 See also: "unique-id-header"
11220
11221unique-id-header <name>
11222 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11224 yes | yes | yes | no
11225 Arguments :
11226 <name> is the name of the header.
11227
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011228 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11229 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011230
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011231 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011232
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011233 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011234 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11235
11236 will generate:
11237
11238 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11239
11240 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011241
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011242use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011243 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11245 no | yes | yes | no
11246 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011247 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11248 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011249
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011250 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11251 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011252
11253 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11254 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11255 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011256 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011257 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011258 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11259 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011260
11261 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11262 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11263 assign the backend.
11264
11265 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11266 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11267 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11268 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11269 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11270 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11271
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011272 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011273 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011274 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11275 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11276 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11277
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011278 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11279 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11280 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11281 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11282 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11283 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11284 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11285 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11286 cannot be forced from the request.
11287
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011288 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011289 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11290 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11291
11292 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11293 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011294
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011295
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011296use-server <server> if <condition>
11297use-server <server> unless <condition>
11298 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11300 no | no | yes | yes
11301 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011302 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011303
11304 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11305
11306 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11307 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11308 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11309
11310 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11311 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11312 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11313 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11314 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11315 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11316 matches will assign the server.
11317
11318 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11319 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11320 with the next rules until one matches.
11321
11322 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11323 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11324 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11325 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11326
11327 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11328 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11329 stripped.
11330
11331 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11332 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11333 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11334 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11335
11336 Example :
11337 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11338 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11339 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11340 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11341 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11342 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011343 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011344 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11345 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11346
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011347 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011348
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011349
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100113505. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011351--------------------------
11352
11353The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11354depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11355settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11356written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11357described in this section.
11358
11359
113605.1. Bind options
11361-----------------
11362
11363The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11364as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11365no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11366parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11367while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11368provided immediately after the setting name.
11369
11370The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11371
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011372accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11373 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11374 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11375 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11376 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11377 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11378 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11379 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11380 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11381 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011382 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11383 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11384 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011385
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011386accept-proxy
11387 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011388 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11389 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011390 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11391 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11392 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11393 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011394 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011395 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11396 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011397 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11398 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011399
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011400allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011401 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011402 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011403 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011404 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11405 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011406
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011407alpn <protocols>
11408 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11409 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11410 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011411 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011412 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011413 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11414 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11415 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11416 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11417 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11418 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11419 preference, like below :
11420
11421 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011422
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011423backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011424 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011425 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11426
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011427curves <curves>
11428 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11429 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11430 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11431 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11432 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11433 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11434
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011435ecdhe <named curve>
11436 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011437 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11438 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011439
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011440ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011441 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11442 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11443 client's certificate.
11444
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011445ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11446 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11447 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11448 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11449 error is ignored.
11450
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011451ca-sign-file <cafile>
11452 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11453 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11454 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11455 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11456 'generate-certificates' for details.
11457
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011458ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011459 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11460 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11461 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11462 'generate-certificates' for details.
11463
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011464ciphers <ciphers>
11465 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11466 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011467 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011468 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011469 information and recommendations see e.g.
11470 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11471 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11472 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11473
11474ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11475 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11476 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11477 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11478 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011479 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11480 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011481
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011482crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011483 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11484 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11485 to verify client's certificate.
11486
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011487crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011488 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11489 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11490 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11491 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11492 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11493 file.
11494
11495 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11496 are loaded.
11497
11498 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011499 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011500 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11501 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11502 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11503 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011504 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11505 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011506 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011507
11508 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11509 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11510 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11511 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011512 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11513 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011514
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011515 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011516
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011517 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011518 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011519 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11520 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011521 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11522 clients).
11523
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011524 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11525 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11526 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11527 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11528 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11529 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11530 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11531 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11532 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11533 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11534 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11535 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11536 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11537
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011538 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11539 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11540 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11541 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11542 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11543
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011544 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11545 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11546 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11547 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011548
11549 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11550 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11551 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11552 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11553 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11554 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11555 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11556 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11557 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11558
11559 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11560
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011561 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011562 a cert bundle.
11563
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011564 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011565 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11566 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11567 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11568 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11569 provide multi-cert support.
11570
11571 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11572
11573 Filename | CN | SAN
11574 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11575 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011576 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011577 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11578 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11579
11580 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11581 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11582 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11583 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011584 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11585 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11586 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011587
11588 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11589 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11590
11591 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11592 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11593 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11594
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011595crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011596 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011597 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011598 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011599 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011600
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011601crt-list <file>
11602 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011603 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11604 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011605
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011606 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11607
William Lallemand0b77c182020-06-30 16:11:36 +020011608 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ciphers",
11609 "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names", "npn",
11610 "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
11611 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
11612 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011613
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011614 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11615 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11616 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11617 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11618 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11619 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11620 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11621 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011622
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011623 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011624 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011625 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11626 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11627 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011628
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011629 crt-list file example:
11630 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011631 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011632 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011633 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011634
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011635defer-accept
11636 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11637 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11638 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011639 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011640 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11641 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11642 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11643 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11644 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11645 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11646 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11647
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011648expose-fd listeners
11649 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11650 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011651 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11652 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011653 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011654
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011655force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011656 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011657 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011658 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011659 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011660
11661force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011662 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011663 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011664 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011665
11666force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011667 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011668 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011669 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011670
11671force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011672 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011673 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011674 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011675
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011676force-tlsv13
11677 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11678 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011679 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011680
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011681generate-certificates
11682 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11683 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11684 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11685 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11686 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11687 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11688 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11689 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11690 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11691 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11692 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11693
11694 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11695 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011696 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011697 certificate is used many times.
11698
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011699gid <gid>
11700 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11701 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11702 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11703 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11704 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11705
11706group <group>
11707 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11708 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11709 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11710 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11711 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11712
11713id <id>
11714 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11715 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11716 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11717 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11718
11719interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011720 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11721 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11722 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11723 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11724 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11725 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011726 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11727 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11728 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11729 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11730 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11731 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011732
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011733level <level>
11734 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11735 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11736 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011737 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011738 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11739 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11740 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011741 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011742 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011743 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011744 all counters).
11745
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011746severity-output <format>
11747 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11748 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11749 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11750 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11751 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11752 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11753 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11754 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11755 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11756 rfc5424 convention.
11757
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011758maxconn <maxconn>
11759 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11760 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11761 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11762 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11763 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11764 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11765 eat all memory.
11766
11767mode <mode>
11768 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11769 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11770 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11771 UNIX sockets.
11772
11773mss <maxseg>
11774 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11775 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11776 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11777 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11778 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11779 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11780 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11781 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11782 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11783 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11784 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11785
11786name <name>
11787 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11788 page.
11789
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011790namespace <name>
11791 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11792 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11793 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11794 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11795
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011796nice <nice>
11797 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11798 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11799 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11800 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11801 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11802 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11803 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11804 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11805 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11806 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11807 one for an RDP socket.
11808
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011809no-ca-names
11810 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11811 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11812
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011813no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011814 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011815 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011816 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011817 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011818 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11819 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011820
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011821no-tls-tickets
11822 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11823 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11824 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011825 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11826 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010011827 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
11828 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
11829 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011830
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011831no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011832 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011833 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011834 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011835 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011836 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11837 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011838
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011839no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011841 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011842 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011843 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011844 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11845 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011846
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011847no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011849 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011850 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011851 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011852 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11853 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011854
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011855no-tlsv13
11856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11857 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11858 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11859 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011860 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11861 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011862
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011863npn <protocols>
11864 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11865 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11866 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011867 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011868 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011869 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11870 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11871 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11872 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11873 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011874
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011875prefer-client-ciphers
11876 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11877 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11878 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011879 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11880 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11881 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011882
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011883process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011884 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011885 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011886 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011887 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11888 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11889 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11890 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011891 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011892 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11893 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11894 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11895 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11896 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011897
11898 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11899
11900 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11901 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11902 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11903 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11904 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11905 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11906 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11907 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011908
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011909proto <name>
11910 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11911 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11912 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11913 in haproxy -vv.
11914 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11915 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011916 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011917 h2" on the bind line.
11918
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011919ssl
11920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011921 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011922 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11923 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011924 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11925 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011926
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011927ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11928 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11929 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11930 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11931
11932ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11933 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11934 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11935 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11936
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011937strict-sni
11938 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11939 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11940 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11941 See the "crt" option for more information.
11942
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011943tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011944 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011945 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11946 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011947 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011948 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11949 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11950 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11951 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11952 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11953 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11954 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11955
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011956tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011957 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011958 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11959 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11960 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11961 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11962 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11963 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11964 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011965 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11966 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11967 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011968
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011969tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11970 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011971 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11972 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11973 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11974 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11975 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11976 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11977 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11978 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11979 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11980 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011981 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11982 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11983
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011984transparent
11985 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11986 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11987 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11988 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11989 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11990 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11991 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11992 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11993 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11994 so check for support with your vendor.
11995
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011996v4v6
11997 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11998 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11999 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12000 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012001 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012002
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012003v6only
12004 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12005 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12006 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012007 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12008 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012009
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012010uid <uid>
12011 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12012 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12013 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12014 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12015 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12016
12017user <user>
12018 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12019 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12020 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12021 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12022 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12023
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012024verify [none|optional|required]
12025 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12026 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12027 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12028 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12029 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012030 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12031 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12032 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12033 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012034
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200120355.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012036------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012038The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12039which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12040arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12041settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12042after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12043Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12044address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012046 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012047 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012048
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012049Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12050keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12051
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012052The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012053
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012054addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012055 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012056 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12057 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12058 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12059 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12060 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012061
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012062agent-check
12063 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012064 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012065 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12066 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12067 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012068
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012069 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012070 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012071 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12072 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12073 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012074
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012075 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12076 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12077 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12078 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12079 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012080
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012081 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012082 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012083
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012084 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12085 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12086 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012087
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012088 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12089 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12090 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012091
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012092 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12093 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12094 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12095 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12096 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012097 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012098 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012099
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012100 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12101 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012102
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012103 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12104 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12105 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12106 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12107 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12108 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12109 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12110 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12111 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012112
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012113 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12114 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012115 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12116 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12117 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012118 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012119
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012120 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012121 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012122
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012123agent-send <string>
12124 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12125 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12126 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12127 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12128 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12129
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012130agent-inter <delay>
12131 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12132 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12133
12134 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12135 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12136 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12137 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12138 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12139 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12140 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12141 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12142 of backends use the same servers.
12143
12144 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12145
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012146agent-addr <addr>
12147 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12148
12149 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12150 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12151 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12152 hostname, it will be resolved.
12153
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012154agent-port <port>
12155 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12156
12157 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12158
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012159allow-0rtt
12160 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012161 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12162 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012163
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012164alpn <protocols>
12165 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12166 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12167 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012168 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012169 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12170 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12171 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12172 now obsolete NPN extension.
12173 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12174 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12175
12176 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012178backup
12179 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12180 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12181 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12182 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012183 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12184 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012185
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012186ca-file <cafile>
12187 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12188 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12189 server's certificate.
12190
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012191check
12192 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012193 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12194 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12195 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12196 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12197 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12198 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12199 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012200 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12201 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012202 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12203 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012204
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012205check-send-proxy
12206 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12207 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12208 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12209 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12210 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12211 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12212 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12213
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012214check-alpn <protocols>
12215 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12216 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12217 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12218
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012219check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012220 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012221 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12222 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012223
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012224check-ssl
12225 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12226 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12227 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12228 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012229 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012230 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12231 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012232 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012233 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12234 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012235
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012236check-via-socks4
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012237 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012238 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12239 for normal traffic.
12240
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012241ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012242 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12243 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12244 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012245 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12246 information and recommendations see e.g.
12247 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12248 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12249 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012250
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012251ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12252 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12253 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12254 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12255 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012256 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12257 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12258 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012260cookie <value>
12261 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12262 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12263 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12264 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12265 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12266 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12267 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12268
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012269crl-file <crlfile>
12270 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12271 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12272 to verify server's certificate.
12273
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012274crt <cert>
12275 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12276 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12277 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12278 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12279 certificate request.
12280
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012281disabled
12282 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12283 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12284 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12285 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12286 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012287 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012288
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012289enabled
12290 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12291 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12292 default value.
12293 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12294 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012295
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012296error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012297 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12298 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12299 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012300
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012301 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012302
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012303fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012304 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12305 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12306 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12307
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012308force-sslv3
12309 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12310 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012311 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012312 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012313
12314force-tlsv10
12315 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012316 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012317 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012318
12319force-tlsv11
12320 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012321 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012322 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012323
12324force-tlsv12
12325 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012326 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012327 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012328
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012329force-tlsv13
12330 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12331 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012332 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012333
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012334id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012335 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12336 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12337 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012338
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012339init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12340 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12341 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012342 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012343 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12344 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12345 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12346 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12347 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12348 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12349 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12350 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12351 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012352 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012353 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12354 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12355 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12356 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12357 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12358 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012359 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012360
12361 Example:
12362 defaults
12363 # never fail on address resolution
12364 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12365
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012366inter <delay>
12367fastinter <delay>
12368downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012369 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12370 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12371 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12372 between checks depending on the server state :
12373
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012374 Server state | Interval used
12375 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12376 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12377 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12378 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12379 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12380 or yet unchecked. |
12381 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12382 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12383 | "inter" otherwise.
12384 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012386 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12387 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12388 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12389 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012390 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12391 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12392 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12393 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12394 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012395
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012396maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012397 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12398 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012399 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12400 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012401 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12402 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12403 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12404 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12405
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012406 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12407 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12408 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12409 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12410 than 50 concurrent requests.
12411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012412maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012413 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12414 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12415 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12416 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12417 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12418 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12419 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12420
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012421max-reuse <count>
12422 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12423 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12424 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12425 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12426 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12427 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12428 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12429 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12430
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012431minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012432 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12433 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12434 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12435 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12436 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12437 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012438 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012439 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012440
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012441namespace <name>
12442 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12443 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12444 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12445 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12446
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012447no-agent-check
12448 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12449 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12450 default value.
12451 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12452 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12453
12454no-backup
12455 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12456 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12457 default value.
12458 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12459 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12460
12461no-check
12462 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12463 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12464 default value.
12465 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12466 "default-server" "check" setting.
12467
12468no-check-ssl
12469 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12470 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12471 default value.
12472 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12473 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12474
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012475no-send-proxy
12476 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12477 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12478 default value.
12479 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12480 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12481
12482no-send-proxy-v2
12483 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12484 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12485 default value.
12486 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12487 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12488
12489no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12490 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12491 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12492 default value.
12493 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12494 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12495
12496no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12497 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12498 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12499 default value.
12500 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12501 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12502
12503no-ssl
12504 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12505 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12506 default value.
12507 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12508 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12509
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012510no-ssl-reuse
12511 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12512 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12513 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12514 and for paranoid users.
12515
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012516no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012517 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12518 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012519 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012520
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012521 Supported in default-server: No
12522
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012523no-tls-tickets
12524 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12525 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12526 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012527 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12528 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012529 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12530 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12531 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012532 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012533
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012534no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012535 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012536 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12537 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012538 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12539 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012540 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012541
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012542 Supported in default-server: No
12543
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012544no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012545 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012546 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12547 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012548 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12549 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012550 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012551
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012552 Supported in default-server: No
12553
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012554no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012555 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012556 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12557 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012558 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12559 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012560 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012561
12562 Supported in default-server: No
12563
12564no-tlsv13
12565 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12566 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12567 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12568 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12569 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012570 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012571
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012572 Supported in default-server: No
12573
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012574no-verifyhost
12575 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12576 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12577 default value.
12578 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12579 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012580
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012581no-tfo
12582 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12583 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12584 default value.
12585 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12586 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12587
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012588non-stick
12589 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12590 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12591 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12592
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012593npn <protocols>
12594 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12595 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12596 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012597 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012598 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12599 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12600 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12601
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012602observe <mode>
12603 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12604 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12605 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12606 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12607 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12608 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012609 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012610
12611 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12612
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012613on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012614 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12615 Currently, four modes are available:
12616 - fastinter: force fastinter
12617 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12618 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12619 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12620 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12621
12622 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12623
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012624on-marked-down <action>
12625 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12626 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012627 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12628 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12629 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12630 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12631 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12632 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12633 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12634 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012635
12636 Actions are disabled by default
12637
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012638on-marked-up <action>
12639 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12640 Currently one action is available:
12641 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12642 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12643 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12644 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012645 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12646 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012647 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12648 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12649
12650 Actions are disabled by default
12651
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012652pool-max-conn <max>
12653 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12654 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12655 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12656 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12657 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12658 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12659
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012660pool-purge-delay <delay>
12661 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012662 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012663 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012664
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012665port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012666 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12667 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12668 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12669 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12670 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12671 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12672
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012673proto <name>
12674
12675 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12676 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12677 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12678 reported in haproxy -vv.
12679 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12680 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12681
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012682redir <prefix>
12683 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12684 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12685 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12686 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12687 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12688 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12689 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12690 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012691 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012692 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012693 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12694 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12695 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12696 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12697
12698 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12699
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012700rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012701 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12702 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12703 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12704
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012705resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12706 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12707 server.
12708
12709 Available options:
12710
12711 * allow-dup-ip
12712 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12713 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12714 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12715 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12716 For such case, simply enable this option.
12717 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12718
12719 * prevent-dup-ip
12720 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12721 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12722 same fqdn.
12723 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12724
12725 Example:
12726 backend b_myapp
12727 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12728 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12729 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12730
12731 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12732 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12733 it
12734 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12735 different address
12736
12737 Default value: not set
12738
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012739resolve-prefer <family>
12740 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12741 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12742 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12743 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12744
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012745 Default value: ipv6
12746
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012747 Example:
12748
12749 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012750
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012751resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012752 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012753 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012754 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012755 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12756 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012757 configured network, another address is selected.
12758
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012759 Example:
12760
12761 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012762
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012763resolvers <id>
12764 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12765 hostname.
12766
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012767 Example:
12768
12769 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012770
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012771 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012772
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012773send-proxy
12774 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12775 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12776 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12777 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012778 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12779 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12780 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12781 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12782 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12783 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12784 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12785 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12786 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12787 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012788 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12789 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012790
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012791send-proxy-v2
12792 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12793 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12794 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12795 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012796 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12797 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12798 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12799 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012800
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012801proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12802 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12803 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012804 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12805 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012806 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12807 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012808 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012809
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012810send-proxy-v2-ssl
12811 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12812 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12813 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12814 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12815 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12816 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12817 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012818 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12819 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012820
12821send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12822 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12823 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12824 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12825 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12826 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12827 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12828 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12829 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012830 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12831 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012832
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012833slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012834 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12835 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12836 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12837 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12838 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12839 parameters :
12840
12841 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12842 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12843
12844 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12845 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12846 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12847 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12848
12849 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12850 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12851 seen as failed.
12852
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012853sni <expression>
12854 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12855 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12856 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12857 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012858 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12859 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012860 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012861 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12862 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012863
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012864source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012865source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012866source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012867 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12868 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12869 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12870 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12871
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012872 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12873 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12874 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12875 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12876 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12877 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12878 server.
12879
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012880 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12881 specifying the source address without port(s).
12882
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012883ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012884 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12885 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12886 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12887 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12888 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12889 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012890 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12891 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012892
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012893ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12894 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12895 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12896 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12897
12898ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12899 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12900 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12901 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12902
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012903ssl-reuse
12904 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12905 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12906 default value.
12907 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12908 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12909
12910stick
12911 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12912 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12913 default value.
12914 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12915 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012916
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012917socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012918 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012919 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12920 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12921
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012922tcp-ut <delay>
12923 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12924 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12925 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012926 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012927 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12928 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12929 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12930 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12931 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12932 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12933 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12934 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12935 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12936
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012937tfo
12938 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12939 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12940 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12941 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12942 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012943 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012944
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012945track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012946 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12947 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12948 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12949 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012950 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12951
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012952tls-tickets
12953 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12954 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12955 default value.
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012956 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12957 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12958 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012959 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke04037d32020-02-13 14:16:16 +010012960 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012961
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012962verify [none|required]
12963 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012964 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012965 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12966 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012967 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012968 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12969 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12970 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12971 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12972 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12973 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12974 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12975 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012976
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012977verifyhost <hostname>
12978 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012979 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12980 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12981 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12982 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12983 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12984 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12985 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12986 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012987
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012988weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012989 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12990 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12991 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012992 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12993 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12994 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12995 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12996 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12997 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012998
12999
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130005.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13001-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013002
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013003HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13004using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13005configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013006This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13007can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13008workload.
13009This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13010resolution at run time.
13011Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13012carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13013
13014
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130155.3.1. Global overview
13016----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013017
13018As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13019different steps of the process life:
13020
13021 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13022 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13023 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13024
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013025 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13026 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013027
13028A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13029 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13030 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13031 resolution to know this new IP.
13032
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013033When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013034HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013035SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13036from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13037will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13038will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013039
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013040A few things important to notice:
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013041 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013042 first valid response.
13043
13044 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13045 servers return an error.
13046
13047
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130485.3.2. The resolvers section
13049----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013050
13051This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013052HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13053contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013054
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013055When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13056uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13057is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13058answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13059
13060When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013061used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013062
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013063 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13064 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13065 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013066
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013067 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13068 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013069
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013070 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13071 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13072 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013073
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013074For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13075following scenarios are possible:
13076
13077 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13078 ignored
13079
13080 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13081 applied
13082
13083 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13084 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13085
13086 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13087 retries the query with a new type
13088
13089 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13090 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013091
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013092As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13093a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013094<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013095
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013096
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013097resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013098 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013099
13100A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13101
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013102accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013103 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013104 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013105 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13106 by RFC 6891)
13107
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013108 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13109
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013110nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13111 DNS server description:
13112 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13113 <ip> : IP address of the server
13114 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13115
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013116parse-resolv-conf
13117 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13118 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13119 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13120
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013121hold <status> <period>
13122 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13123 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013124 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013125 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013126 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13127 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13128 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13129
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013130 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013131
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013132resolve_retries <nb>
13133 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13134 giving up.
13135 Default value: 3
13136
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013137 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13138 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13139 type.
13140
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013141timeout <event> <time>
13142 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13143 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13144 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013145 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13146 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013147 Default value: 1s
13148 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013149 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013150 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013151 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13152 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13153
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013154 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013155
13156 resolvers mydns
13157 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13158 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013159 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013160 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013161 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013162 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013163 hold other 30s
13164 hold refused 30s
13165 hold nx 30s
13166 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013167 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013168 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013169
13170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131716. HTTP header manipulation
13172---------------------------
13173
13174In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
13175response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
13176request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
13177which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013178against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013179
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013180If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
13181to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
13182but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
13183HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
13184stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
13185because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
13186a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
13187still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020013188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013189This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
13190in section 4.2 :
13191
13192 - reqadd <string>
13193 - reqallow <search>
13194 - reqiallow <search>
13195 - reqdel <search>
13196 - reqidel <search>
13197 - reqdeny <search>
13198 - reqideny <search>
13199 - reqpass <search>
13200 - reqipass <search>
13201 - reqrep <search> <replace>
13202 - reqirep <search> <replace>
13203 - reqtarpit <search>
13204 - reqitarpit <search>
13205 - rspadd <string>
13206 - rspdel <search>
13207 - rspidel <search>
13208 - rspdeny <search>
13209 - rspideny <search>
13210 - rsprep <search> <replace>
13211 - rspirep <search> <replace>
13212
13213With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
13214is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
13215parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
13216prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
13217Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
13218
13219 \t for a tab
13220 \r for a carriage return (CR)
13221 \n for a new line (LF)
13222 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
13223 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
13224 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
13225 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
13226 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
13227
13228The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
13229portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
13230above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
13231regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
132329 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
13233is very common to users of the "sed" program.
13234
13235The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
13236after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
13237
13238Notes related to these keywords :
13239---------------------------------
13240 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
13241 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
13242 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
13243
13244 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
13245 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
13246 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
13247
13248 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
13249 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
13250 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
13251 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
13252 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
13253
13254 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
13255 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
13256 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
13257 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
13258 useless headers before adding new ones.
13259
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013260 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013261 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
13262
13263 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
13264 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
13265 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
13266
13267 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
13268 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013269 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013270
13271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132727. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13273----------------------------------
13274
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013275HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013276client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13277The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13278these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13279but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13280data called patterns.
13281
13282
132837.1. ACL basics
13284---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013285
13286The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13287content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13288from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13289simple :
13290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013291 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013292 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013293 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13294 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013296The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13297adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013298
13299In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013301 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013302
13303This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13304Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13305and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013306an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13307conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13308as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13309are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013310
13311ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13312'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13313which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13314
13315There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13316performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013318The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13319specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13320this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013321methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13322ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013323
13324Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13325 - boolean
13326 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13327 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13328 - string
13329 - data block
13330
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013331Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13332converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13333would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13334The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13335which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13336
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013337Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13338keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13339fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13340which are summarized in the table below :
13341
13342 +---------------------+-----------------+
13343 | Sample or converter | Default |
13344 | output type | matching method |
13345 +---------------------+-----------------+
13346 | boolean | bool |
13347 +---------------------+-----------------+
13348 | integer | int |
13349 +---------------------+-----------------+
13350 | ip | ip |
13351 +---------------------+-----------------+
13352 | string | str |
13353 +---------------------+-----------------+
13354 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13355 +---------------------+-----------------+
13356
13357Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13358matching method, see below.
13359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013360The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13361 - boolean
13362 - integer or integer range
13363 - IP address / network
13364 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13365 - regular expression
13366 - hex block
13367
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013368The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13369
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013370 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13371 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013372 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013373 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013374 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013375 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013376 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013378The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13379read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13380if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13381lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13382will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13383beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13384a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13385lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13386exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13387
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013388The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13389parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13390ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13391a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13392check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13393
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013394The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13395socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13396file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013398Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13399loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13400
13401 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13402
13403In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13404the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13405case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13406as well.
13407
13408The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13409sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13410do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13411methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13412is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013413obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013414followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13415default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13416that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13417string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13418
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013419The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13420By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13421string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13422resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13423server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013424waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013425flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13426function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013428There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13429sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13430be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013431
13432 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13433 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013434 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13435 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13436 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13437 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013438
13439 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13440 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013441 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013442
13443 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013444 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013445
13446 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013447 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013448
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013449 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013450 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13451
13452 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13453 binary or string samples.
13454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013455 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13456 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013458 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13459 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13460 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013462 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13463 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013465 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13466 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013468 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13469 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013471 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13472 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013473 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013475 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13476 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13477 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013478
13479For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13480request, it is possible to do :
13481
13482 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13483
13484In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13485buffer, one would use the following acl :
13486
13487 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13488
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013489On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13490possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13491
13492 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013494All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13495criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13496method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13497to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13498criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13499the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013501If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013502the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13503For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013505 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13506 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13507 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13508 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013509
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013510
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013511The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13512types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13513combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13514brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13515default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013517 +-------------------------------------------------+
13518 | Input sample type |
13519 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013520 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013521 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13522 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13523 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013524 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013525 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013526 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013527 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013528 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013529 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013530 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013531 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013532 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013533 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013534 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013535 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013536 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013537 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013538 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013539 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013540 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013541 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013542 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013543 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013544 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013545 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13546 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13547 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013548
13549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135507.1.1. Matching booleans
13551------------------------
13552
13553In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13554Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13555When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13556that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13557
13558Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13559return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13560"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13561
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135637.1.2. Matching integers
13564------------------------
13565
13566Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13567enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13568to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13569
13570Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13571matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13572lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013573
13574For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13575unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13576representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13577
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013578As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13579two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13580instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13581ranges and operators.
13582
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013583For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013584operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13585Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13586of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013587
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013588Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013589
13590 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13591 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13592 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13593 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13594 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13595
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013596For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013597
13598 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13599
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013600This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13601
13602 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13603
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136057.1.3. Matching strings
13606-----------------------
13607
13608String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13609different forms :
13610
13611 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013612 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013613
13614 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013615 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013616
13617 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13618 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13619
13620 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13621 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13622
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013623 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013624 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13625 matches.
13626
13627 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13628 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13629 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013630
13631String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13632exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13633characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13634string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13635to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013636before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013637
Mathias Weiersmuellerb2fe2232019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013638Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13639(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13640Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13641
13642Example:
13643 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13644 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13645
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136477.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13648---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013649
13650Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13651they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13652possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13653passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13654the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013655the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13656match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013657
13658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136597.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13660-------------------------------------
13661
13662It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13663not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13664a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13665to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13666digits may be used upper or lower case.
13667
13668Example :
13669 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13670 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13671
13672
136737.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13674---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013675
13676IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13677netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13678within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013679host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013680difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13681at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13682does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13683parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013684
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013685The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13686abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13687
13688 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13689 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13690 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13691 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13692 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13693 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13694 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13695 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13696
13697Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13698192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13699
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013700IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13701Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13702trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13703IPv6 patterns.
13704
13705HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13706following situations :
13707 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13708 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13709 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13710 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13711 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13712 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13713 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13714 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13715 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13716 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013718
137197.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13720----------------------------------
13721
13722Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13723combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13724
13725 - AND (implicit)
13726 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13727 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013729A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013731 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013733Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13734indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013736For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13737"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13738requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13739is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13740
13741 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013742 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13743 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13744 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013745
13746To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13747and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13748
13749 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13750 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13751 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13752 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13753
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013754 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013755 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13756 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13757 use_backend www if host_www
13758
13759It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13760expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13761be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13762the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13763
13764 The following rule :
13765
13766 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013767 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013768
13769 Can also be written that way :
13770
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013771 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013772
13773It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13774to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13775simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13776sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13777good use is the following :
13778
13779 With named ACLs :
13780
13781 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13782 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13783 monitor fail if site_dead
13784
13785 With anonymous ACLs :
13786
13787 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13788
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013789See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13790keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013791
13792
137937.3. Fetching samples
13794---------------------
13795
13796Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13797against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13798sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13799ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13800of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13801available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13802
13803This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13804Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13805compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13806deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13807
13808The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13809matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13810method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13811indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13812
13813As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13814when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13815mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13816the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13817ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13818
13819Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13820multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13821when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013822incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13823are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013824is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13825all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13826
13827Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13828 - name
13829 - name(arg1)
13830 - name(arg1,arg2)
13831
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013832
138337.3.1. Converters
13834-----------------
13835
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013836Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13837of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13838is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13839was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013840has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013841unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13842
13843These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13844sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13845the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013846support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013847
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013848A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13849support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13850supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13851(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13852bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013854The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013855
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001385651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13857 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13858 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13859 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13860 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13861 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13862
13863 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013864 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13865 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013866 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13867 frontend http-in
13868 bind *:8081
13869 default_backend servers
13870 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13871 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13872
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013873add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013874 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013875 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013876 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13877 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013878 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013879 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13880 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13881 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13882 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013883 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013884 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013885
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013886aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13887 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13888 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13889 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13890 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13891 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13892 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13893
13894 Example:
13895 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13896 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13897
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013898and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013899 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013900 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013901 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13902 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013903 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013904 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13905 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13906 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13907 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013908 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013909 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013910
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013911b64dec
13912 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13913 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13914
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013915base64
13916 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013917 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013918 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13919
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013920bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013921 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013922 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013923 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013924 presence of a flag).
13925
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013926bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13927 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13928 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013929 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013930
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013931concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13932 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13933 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13934 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13935 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13936 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13937 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13938 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13939 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13940 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13941 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013942 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013943 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013944 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013945
13946 Example:
13947 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13948 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13949 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13950 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13951
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013952cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013953 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13954 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013955
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013956crc32([<avalanche>])
13957 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13958 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13959 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13960 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13961 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13962 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13963 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13964 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13965 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13966 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013967 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13968
13969crc32c([<avalanche>])
13970 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13971 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13972 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13973 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13974 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13975 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13976 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13977 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013978
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013979da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013980 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13981 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13982 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13983 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013984 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013985 configuration language.
13986
13987 Example:
13988 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013989 bind *:8881
13990 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013991 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013992
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013993debug
13994 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13995 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13996 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13997
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013998div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013999 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14000 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014001 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014002 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14003 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014004 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014005 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14006 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14007 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14008 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014009 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014010 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014011
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014012djb2([<avalanche>])
14013 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14014 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14015 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14016 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14017 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14018 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14019 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014020 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14021 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014022
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014023even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014024 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014025 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14026
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014027field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14028 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14029 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14030 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14031 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14032 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14033 fields.
14034
14035 Example :
14036 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14037 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14038 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14039 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14040 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014041
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014042hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014043 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014044 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014045 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014046 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014047
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014048hex2i
14049 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014050 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014051
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014052http_date([<offset>])
14053 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14054 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
14055 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
14056 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
14057 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
14058 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014059
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014060in_table(<table>)
14061 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14062 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14063 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014064 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014065 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14066
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014067ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14068 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014069 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014070 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14071 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14072 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14073 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14074 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014075
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014076json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014077 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014078 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014079 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014080 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14081 of errors:
14082 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14083 bytes, ...)
14084 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14085 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14086
14087 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14088 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14089 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14090 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14091 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14092 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014093 - "ascii" : never fails;
14094 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14095 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014096 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014097 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014098 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14099 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14100
14101 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014102 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014103
14104 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014105 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014106 capture request header user-agent len 150
14107 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014108
14109 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14110 GET / HTTP/1.0
14111 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14112
14113 Output log:
14114 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14115
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014116language(<value>[,<default>])
14117 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14118 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14119 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14120 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14121 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14122 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14123 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14124 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14125 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014126 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014127 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14128 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014129
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014130 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014131
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014132 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14133 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014134
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014135 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14136 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14137 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14138 use_backend spanish if es
14139 use_backend french if fr
14140 use_backend english if en
14141 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014142
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014143length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014144 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14145 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14146 type. The result is of type integer.
14147
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014148lower
14149 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14150 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14151 type. The result is of type string.
14152
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014153ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14154 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14155 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14156 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14157 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14158 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14159 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14160
14161 Example :
14162
14163 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014164 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014165 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14166
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014167map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14168map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14169map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14170 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14171 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14172 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14173 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14174 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14175 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14176 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14177 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014178
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014179 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14180 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14181 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014182
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014183 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014184 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014185
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014186 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14187 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14188 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14189 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014190 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14191 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014192 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14193 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14194 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14195 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14196 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14197 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14198 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14199 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014200 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14201 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14202 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014203 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14204 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14205 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14206 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14207 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014208
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014209 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14210 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14211 the corresponding match text.
14212
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014213 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14214 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14215 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14216 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14217 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014218
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014219 Example :
14220
14221 # this is a comment and is ignored
14222 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14223 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14224 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14225 | | | `---------- value
14226 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14227 | `---------------------------- key
14228 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14229
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014230mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014231 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14232 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014233 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014234 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014235 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014236 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14237 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14238 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14239 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014240 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014241 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014242
14243mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014244 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014245 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14246 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014247 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014248 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014249 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014250 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14251 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14252 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14253 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014254 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014255 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014256
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014257nbsrv
14258 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14259 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14260 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14261 map lookup.
14262
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014263neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014264 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14265 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14266 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14267 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014268
14269not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014270 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014271 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014272 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014273 absence of a flag).
14274
14275odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014276 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014277 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14278
14279or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014280 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014281 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014282 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14283 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014284 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014285 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14286 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14287 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14288 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014289 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014290 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014291
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014292protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14293 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14294 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14295 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14296 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14297 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14298 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14299 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14300 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14301 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14302 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14303 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14304
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014305regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014306 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14307 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14308 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14309 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14310 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14311 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14312 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14313 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14314 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
14315 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010014316 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
14317 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
14318 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
14319 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014320
14321 Example :
14322
14323 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14324 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14325 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14326 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14327
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014328capture-req(<id>)
14329 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14330 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14331
14332 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014333 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14334 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014335
14336capture-res(<id>)
14337 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14338 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14339
14340 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014341 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14342 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014343
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014344sdbm([<avalanche>])
14345 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14346 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14347 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14348 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14349 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14350 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14351 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014352 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14353 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014354
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014355set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014356 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14357 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14358 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014359 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014360 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14361 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014362 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014363 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14364 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014365 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014366 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014367
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014368sha1
14369 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
14370 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14371
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014372strcmp(<var>)
14373 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14374 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14375 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14376 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14377 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14378 shorter).
14379
14380 Example :
14381
14382 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14383 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14384 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14385
14386
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014387sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014388 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14389 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014390 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014391 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14392 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014393 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014394 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14395 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014396 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014397 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14398 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014399 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014400 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014401
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014402table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14403 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14404 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14405 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14406 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14407 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14408 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14409
14410
14411table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14412 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14413 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14414 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14415 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14416 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14417 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14418
14419table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14420 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14421 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014422 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014423 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14424 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14425
14426table_conn_cur(<table>)
14427 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14428 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14429 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14430 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14431 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14432
14433table_conn_rate(<table>)
14434 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14435 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14436 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14437 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14438 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14439
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014440table_gpt0(<table>)
14441 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14442 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14443 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14444 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14445 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14446
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014447table_gpc0(<table>)
14448 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14449 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14450 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14451 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14452 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14453
14454table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14455 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14456 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14457 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14458 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14459 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14460 sample fetch keyword.
14461
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014462table_gpc1(<table>)
14463 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14464 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14465 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14466 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14467 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14468
14469table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14470 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14471 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14472 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14473 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14474 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14475 sample fetch keyword.
14476
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014477table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14478 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14479 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014480 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014481 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14482 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14483
14484table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14485 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14486 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14487 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14488 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14489 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14490 keyword.
14491
14492table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14493 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14494 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014495 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014496 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14497 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14498
14499table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14500 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14501 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14502 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14503 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14504 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14505 keyword.
14506
14507table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14508 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14509 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014510 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014511 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14512 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14513 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14514 keyword.
14515
14516table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14517 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14518 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014519 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014520 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14521 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14522 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14523 keyword.
14524
14525table_server_id(<table>)
14526 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14527 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14528 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14529 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14530 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14531 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14532
14533table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14534 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14535 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014536 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014537 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14538 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14539 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14540 keyword.
14541
14542table_sess_rate(<table>)
14543 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14544 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14545 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14546 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14547 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14548 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14549 keyword.
14550
14551table_trackers(<table>)
14552 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14553 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14554 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14555 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14556 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14557 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14558 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14559 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14560 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14561 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14562
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014563upper
14564 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14565 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14566 type. The result is of type string.
14567
Willy Tarreau7e913cb2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020014568url_dec([<in_form>])
14569 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
14570 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
14571 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
14572 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
14573 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
14574 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014575
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014576ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014577 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014578 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14579 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14580 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014581 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14582 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14583 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14584 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014585 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014586 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14587 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014588
14589 Example:
14590 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14591 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14592
14593 message Point {
14594 int32 latitude = 1;
14595 int32 longitude = 2;
14596 }
14597
14598 message PPoint {
14599 Point point = 59;
14600 }
14601
14602 message Rectangle {
14603 // One corner of the rectangle.
14604 PPoint lo = 48;
14605 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14606 PPoint hi = 49;
14607 }
14608
14609 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14610 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14611 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14612
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014613 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14614 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014615 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014616 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14617
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014618 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014619
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014620 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014621
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014622 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014623 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14624 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14625
14626 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14627 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14628 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14629
14630 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14631 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14632 interpret the previous binary sample.
14633
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014634
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014635unset-var(<var name>)
14636 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14637 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14638 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14639 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14640 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14641 response),
14642 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14643 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14644 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14645 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14646
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014647utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14648 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14649 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14650 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14651 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14652 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14653 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14654
14655 Example :
14656
14657 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014658 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014659 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14660
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014661word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14662 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14663 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14664 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnind1fa5fa2020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014665 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014666 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14667 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14668
14669 Example :
14670 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14671 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14672 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14673 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14674 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnind1fa5fa2020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014675 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014676
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014677wt6([<avalanche>])
14678 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14679 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14680 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14681 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14682 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14683 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14684 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014685 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14686 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014687
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014688xor(<value>)
14689 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014690 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014691 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014692 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014693 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014694 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14695 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014696 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014697 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14698 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014699 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014700 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014701
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014702xxh32([<seed>])
14703 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14704 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14705 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14706 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14707 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14708 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14709 as cryptographically secure.
14710
14711xxh64([<seed>])
14712 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14713 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14714 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14715 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14716 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14717 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14718 as cryptographically secure.
14719
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014720
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200147217.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014722--------------------------------------------
14723
14724A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14725not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14726"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14727The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14728
14729always_false : boolean
14730 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14731 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14732
14733always_true : boolean
14734 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14735 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14736
14737avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014738 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014739 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14740 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14741 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14742 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14743 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14744 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14745 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14746 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14747 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14748 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14749 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14750 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14751 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014753be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014754 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14755 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14756 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14757 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014758 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14759
14760be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14761 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14762 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14763 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14764 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14765 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014766 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14767 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014768
14769 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14770 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14771 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014773be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14774 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14775 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14776 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014777 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014778 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14779 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014780
14781 Example :
14782 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14783 backend dynamic
14784 mode http
14785 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14786 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014787
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014788bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014789 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14790 of the string.
14791
14792bool(<bool>) : bool
14793 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14794 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014796connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14797 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014798 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014799 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14800 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014801
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014802 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014803 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014804 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14805
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014806 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14807 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014808
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014809 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014810 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014811 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014812 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014813 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014814 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014815 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014816
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014817 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14818 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014819 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014820 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014821
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014822cpu_calls : integer
14823 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14824 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14825 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14826 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14827 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14828 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14829
14830cpu_ns_avg : integer
14831 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14832 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14833 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14834 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14835 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14836 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14837 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14838 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14839 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14840 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14841 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14842
14843cpu_ns_tot : integer
14844 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14845 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14846 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14847 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14848 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14849 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14850 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14851 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14852 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14853 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14854 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14855 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14856 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14857
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014858date([<offset>]) : integer
14859 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14860 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14861 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14862 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014863 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14864
14865 Example :
14866
14867 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14868 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014869
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014870date_us : integer
14871 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14872 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14873 from the same timeval structure.
14874
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014875distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14876 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14877 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14878 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14879 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14880 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14881 list of supported tokens.
14882
14883distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14884 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14885 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14886 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14887 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14888 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14889 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14890 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14891 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14892 supported tokens.
14893
14894 Example :
14895 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14896 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14897 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14898 # send large files to the big farm
14899 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14900
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014901env(<name>) : string
14902 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14903 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14904 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14905 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14906 certain way.
14907
14908 Examples :
14909 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14910 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14911
14912 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14913 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014915fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14916 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014917 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14918 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014919 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14920 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014921 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014922 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14923 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014924
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014925fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14926 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14927 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14928 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014930fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14931 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14932 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14933 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14934 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14935 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14936 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14937 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14938 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014939
14940 Example :
14941 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14942 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14943 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14944 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14945 frontend mail
14946 bind :25
14947 mode tcp
14948 maxconn 100
14949 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14950 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14951 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14952 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014953
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014954hostname : string
14955 Returns the system hostname.
14956
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014957int(<integer>) : signed integer
14958 Returns a signed integer.
14959
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014960ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14961 Returns an ipv4.
14962
14963ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14964 Returns an ipv6.
14965
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014966lat_ns_avg : integer
14967 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14968 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14969 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14970 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14971 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14972 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14973 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14974 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14975 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14976 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14977 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14978 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14979 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14980 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14981
14982lat_ns_tot : integer
14983 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14984 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14985 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14986 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14987 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14988 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14989 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14990 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14991 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14992 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14993 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14994 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14995 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14996 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14997 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14998 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14999 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15000 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15001 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15002
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015003meth(<method>) : method
15004 Returns a method.
15005
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015006nbproc : integer
15007 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15008 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15009 and debugging purposes.
15010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015011nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15012 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15013 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15014 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015015 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15016 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15017 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015018
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015019prio_class : integer
15020 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15021 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15022 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15023
15024prio_offset : integer
15025 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15026 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15027 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15028 set-priority-offset".
15029
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015030proc : integer
15031 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15032 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15033 debugging purposes.
15034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015035queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015036 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15037 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15038 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015039 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15040 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15041 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15042 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15043 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15044
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015045rand([<range>]) : integer
15046 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15047 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15048 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15049 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15050 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15051
Luca Schimweg77306662019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015052uuid([<version>]) : string
15053 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15054 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15055 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015057srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15058 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15059 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15060 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15061 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15062 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015063 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15064 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15065
15066srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15067 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15068 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15069 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15070 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15071 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15072 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15073 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15074
15075 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15076 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015077
15078srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15079 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15080 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15081 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015082 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015083 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15084 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15085 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15086
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015087srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15088 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15089 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15090 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15091 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15092 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15093 fetch methods.
15094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015095srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15096 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15097 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015098 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015099 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15100 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015101 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015102 overloading servers).
15103
15104 Example :
15105 # Redirect to a separate back
15106 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15107 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15108 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15109
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015110stopping : boolean
15111 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15112 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15113 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15114
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015115str(<string>) : string
15116 Returns a string.
15117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015118table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15119 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15120 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15121
15122table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15123 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15124 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15125 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15126
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015127thread : integer
15128 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15129 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15130 and debugging purposes.
15131
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015132var(<var-name>) : undefined
15133 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015134 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15135 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015136 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015137 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15138 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015139 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015140 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15141 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015142 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015143 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015144
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151457.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015146----------------------------------
15147
15148The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15149closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15150methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15151sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15152TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015153the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15154counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015155"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15156used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15157can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15158Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15159table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15160tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15161currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015162
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015163bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015164 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15165 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15166 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015168be_id : integer
15169 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15170 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15171
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015172be_name : string
15173 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15174 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015176dst : ip
15177 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15178 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15179 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15180 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015181 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15182 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15183 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15184 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15185 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15186 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015187
15188dst_conn : integer
15189 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15190 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15191 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15192 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15193 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15194 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15195 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15196 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015197
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015198dst_is_local : boolean
15199 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15200 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15201 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15202 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015203 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015204 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15205 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15206 it only once per connection.
15207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015208dst_port : integer
15209 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15210 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15211 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15212 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15213 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15214 an HTTP header.
15215
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015216fc_http_major : integer
15217 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15218 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15219 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15220
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015221fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15222 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15223 header.
15224
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015225fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15226 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15227 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15228 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15229 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15230 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15231 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15232
15233fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15234 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15235 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15236 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15237 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15238 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15239 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15240
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015241fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015242 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15243 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15244 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15245 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15246
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015247fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015248 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15249 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15250 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15251 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15252
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015253fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015254 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15255 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15256 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15257 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15258
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015259fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015260 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15261 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15262 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15263 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15264
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015265fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015266 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15267 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15268 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15269 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15270
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015271fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015272 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15273 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15274 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15275 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15276
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015277fe_defbe : string
15278 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15279 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015281fe_id : integer
15282 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015283 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015284 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15285
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015286fe_name : string
15287 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15288 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15289 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15290
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015291sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015292sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15293sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15294sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015295 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15296 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15297 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15298
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015299sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015300sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15301sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15302sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015303 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15304 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15305 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15306
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015307sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015308sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15309sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15310sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015311 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15312 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015313 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15314 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15315 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015316
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015317 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015318 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15319 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015320 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15321 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15322 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015323 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15324 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15325
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015326sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15327sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15328sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15329sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15330 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15331 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15332 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15333 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15334 when a first ACL was verified.
15335
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015336sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015337sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15338sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15339sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015340 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015341 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15342
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015343sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015344sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15345sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15346sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015347 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15348 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15349 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15350
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015351sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015352sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15353sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15354sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015355 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15356 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15357 See also src_conn_rate.
15358
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015359sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015360sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15361sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15362sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015363 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015364 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015365
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015366sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15367sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15368sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15369sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15370 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15371 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15372
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015373sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15374sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15375sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15376sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15377 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15378 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15379
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015380sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015381sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15382sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15383sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015384 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15385 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15386 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015387 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15388 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15389 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015390
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015391sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15392sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15393sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15394sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15395 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15396 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15397 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15398 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15399 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15400 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15401
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015402sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015403sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15404sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15405sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015406 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015407 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15408 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15409
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015410sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015411sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15412sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15413sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015414 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15415 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15416 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15417 src_http_err_rate.
15418
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015419sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015420sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15421sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15422sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015423 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015424 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15425 src_http_req_cnt.
15426
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015427sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015428sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15429sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15430sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015431 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15432 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15433 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15434 src_http_req_rate.
15435
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015436sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015437sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15438sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15439sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015440 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015441 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15442 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15443 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15444 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015445
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015446 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015447 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15448 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015449 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15450
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015451sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15452sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15453sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15454sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15455 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15456 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15457 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15458 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15459 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15460
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015461sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015462sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15463sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15464sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015465 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15466 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15467 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015468
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015469sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015470sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15471sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15472sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015473 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15474 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15475 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015476
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015477sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015478sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15479sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15480sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015481 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015482 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15483 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15484 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015485 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015486 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15487
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015488sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015489sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15490sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15491sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015492 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15493 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15494 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15495 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15496 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015497 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015498
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015499sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015500sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15501sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15502sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015503 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15504 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15505 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15506
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015507sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015508sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15509sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15510sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015511 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15512 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015513 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015514 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15515 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015516 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15517 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15518 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015520so_id : integer
15521 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15522 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15523 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015524
Jerome Magnin28b90332020-03-27 22:08:40 +010015525so_name : string
15526 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
15527 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
15528 strings instead of integers.
15529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015530src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015531 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015532 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15533 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15534 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015535 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15536 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15537 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015538 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15539 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15540 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15541 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15542 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15543 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15544 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015545
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015546 Example:
15547 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15548 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015550src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15551 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15552 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15553 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015554 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015556src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15557 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15558 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015559 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015560 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015562src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15563 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15564 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15565 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15566 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15567 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15568 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015569
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015570 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015571 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15572 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15573 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15574 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015575 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015576 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15577 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15578
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015579src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15580 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15581 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15582 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15583 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15584 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15585 was verified.
15586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015587src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015588 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015589 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015590 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015591 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015593src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015594 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015595 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15596 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015597 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015599src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15600 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15601 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15602 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015603 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015605src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015606 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015607 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015608 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015609 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015610
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015611src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15612 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15613 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15614 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15615 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15616
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015617src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15618 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15619 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15620 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15621 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015623src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015624 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015625 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015626 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15627 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015628 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15629 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15630 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015631
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015632src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15633 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15634 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15635 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15636 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15637 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15638 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15639 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015641src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015642 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015643 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015644 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015645 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015646 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015648src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15649 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15650 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15651 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15652 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015653 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015655src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015656 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15658 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015659 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015661src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15662 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15663 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15664 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015665 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015666 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015668src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15669 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15670 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15671 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015672 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015673 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15674 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015675
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015676 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015677 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015678 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015679 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015680
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015681src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15682 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15683 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15684 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15685 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15686 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15687 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15688
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015689src_is_local : boolean
15690 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15691 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15692 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15693 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015694 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015695 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15696 once per connection.
15697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015698src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015699 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15700 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15701 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15702 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15703 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015705src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015706 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15707 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15708 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15709 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15710 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015712src_port : integer
15713 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15714 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15715 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15716 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015718src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015719 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015720 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15721 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15722 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015723 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015725src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15726 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15727 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15728 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15729 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015730 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015732src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15733 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15734 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15735 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15736 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15737 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15738 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15739 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15740 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015741
15742 Example :
15743 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15744 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15745 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15746 listen ssh
15747 bind :22
15748 mode tcp
15749 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015750 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015751 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015752 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015754srv_id : integer
15755 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15756 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15757 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015758
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157597.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015760----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015762The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15763closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15764when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15765usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015766future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015767
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001576851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15769 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15770 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15771 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15772 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15773 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15774
15775 Example :
15776 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15777 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15778 # the request.
15779 frontend http-in
15780 bind *:8081
15781 default_backend servers
15782 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15783 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15784
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015785ssl_bc : boolean
15786 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15787 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15788 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15789
15790ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15791 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15792 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15793
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015794ssl_bc_alpn : string
15795 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15796 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015797 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015798 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15799 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15800 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15801 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15802 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15803 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15804
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015805ssl_bc_cipher : string
15806 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15807 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15808
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015809ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15810 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15811 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15812 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15813
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015814ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15815 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15816 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15817 session or a TLS ticket.
15818
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015819ssl_bc_npn : string
15820 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15821 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015822 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015823 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15824 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15825 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15826 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15827 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15828
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015829ssl_bc_protocol : string
15830 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15831 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15832
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015833ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015834 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015835 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15836 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015837
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015838ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15839 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15840 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15841 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15842
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015843ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15844 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15845 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15846 if session was reused or not.
15847
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015848ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15849 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15850 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15851 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15852 BoringSSL.
15853
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015854ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15855 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15856 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015858ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15859 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15860 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15861 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15862 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15863 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015865ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15866 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15867 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15868 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15869 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015870
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015871ssl_c_der : binary
15872 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15873 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15874 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015876ssl_c_err : integer
15877 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15878 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15879 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15880 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15881 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015883ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15884 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15885 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15886 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15887 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15888 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15889 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15890 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15891 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015893ssl_c_key_alg : string
15894 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15895 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15896 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015898ssl_c_notafter : string
15899 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15900 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15901 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015903ssl_c_notbefore : string
15904 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15905 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15906 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015908ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15909 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15910 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15911 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15912 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15913 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15914 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15915 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15916 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015918ssl_c_serial : binary
15919 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15920 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15921 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015923ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15924 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15925 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15926 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015927 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15928 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15929
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015930 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015931 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015933ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15934 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15935 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15936 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938ssl_c_used : boolean
15939 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15940 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015942ssl_c_verify : integer
15943 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15944 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15945 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15946 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015948ssl_c_version : integer
15949 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15950 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015951
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015952ssl_f_der : binary
15953 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15954 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15955 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015957ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15958 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15959 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15960 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15961 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015962 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015963 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15964 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15965 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015967ssl_f_key_alg : string
15968 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15969 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15970 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015972ssl_f_notafter : string
15973 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15974 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15975 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015977ssl_f_notbefore : string
15978 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15979 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15980 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015982ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15983 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15984 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15985 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15986 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15987 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15988 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15989 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15990 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015992ssl_f_serial : binary
15993 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15994 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15995 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015996
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015997ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15998 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15999 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16000 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016002ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16003 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16004 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16005 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016007ssl_f_version : integer
16008 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16009 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16010
16011ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016012 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16013 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16014 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016016 Example :
16017 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16018 listen http-https
16019 bind :80
16020 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16021 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16022
16023ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16024 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16025 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16026
16027ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016028 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016029 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16030 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16031 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16032 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16033 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16034 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16035 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16036 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016038ssl_fc_cipher : string
16039 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16040 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016041
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016042ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16043 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16044 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016045 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016046
16047ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16048 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16049 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016050 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016051
16052ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16053 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16054 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16055 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016056 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016057 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016058
16059ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16060 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16061 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016062 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016063
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016064ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16065 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16066 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16067 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016069ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016070 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16071 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016072 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16073 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16074 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16075 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016076
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016077ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16078 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16079 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16080 wait until the handshake happened.
16081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016082ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16083 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016084 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16085 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016086 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016087 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016088
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016089ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016090 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016091 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16092 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016094ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016095 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016096 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16097 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16098 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16099 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16100 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16101 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16102 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016104ssl_fc_protocol : string
16105 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16106 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016107
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016108ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016109 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016110 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16111 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016112
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016113ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16114 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16115 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16116 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016118ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16119 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16120 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16121 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16122 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016123
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016124ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16125 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16126 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16127 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16128 BoringSSL.
16129
16130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016131ssl_fc_sni : string
16132 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16133 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16134 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16135 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16136 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16137
16138 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16139 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16140 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016141 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016142 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016144 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016145 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16146 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016148ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16149 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16150 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016151
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016152
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161537.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016154------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016156Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16157sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16158only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16159For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16160be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16161can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16162sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16163for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16164content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016166payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016167 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016168 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16169 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016171payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16172 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016173 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016174 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016175
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016176req.hdrs : string
16177 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16178 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16179 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16180 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16181
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016182req.hdrs_bin : binary
16183 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16184 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16185 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16186 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16187 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16188 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16189
16190 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16191
16192 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16193 str: <int:length><bytes>
16194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016195req.len : integer
16196req_len : integer (deprecated)
16197 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16198 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16199 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16200 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16201 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16202 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16203 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16204 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016206req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16207 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016208 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16209 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16210 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16211 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016213 ACL alternatives :
16214 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016216req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16217 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16218 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16219 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16220 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016222 ACL alternatives :
16223 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016225 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016227req.proto_http : boolean
16228req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16229 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16230 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16231 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16232 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16233 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16234 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16235 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016237 Example:
16238 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16239 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16240 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016241 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016243req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16244rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16245 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16246 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16247 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16248 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16249 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16250 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16251 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016253 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16254 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16255 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16256 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16257 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16258 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016260 ACL derivatives :
16261 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016263 Example :
16264 listen tse-farm
16265 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16266 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16267 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16268 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16269 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16270 persist rdp-cookie
16271 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16272 # This is only useful makes sense if
16273 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16274 stick-table type string size 204800
16275 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16276 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16277 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016279 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16280 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016282req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16283rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16284 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16285 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16286 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16287 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016289 ACL derivatives :
16290 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016291
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016292req.ssl_alpn : string
16293 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16294 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16295 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16296 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16297 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16298 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016299 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016300
16301 Examples :
16302 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16303 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16304 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016305 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016306 default_backend bk_default
16307
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016308req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16309 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16310 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016311 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16312 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16313 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16314 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16315 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016317req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16318req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16319 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16320 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16321 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16322 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16323 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16324 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16325 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016327req.ssl_sni : string
16328req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16329 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16330 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16331 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16332 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16333 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16334 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16335 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16336 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16337 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16338 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16339 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16340 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016342 ACL derivatives :
16343 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016345 Examples :
16346 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16347 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16348 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16349 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16350 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016351
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016352req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16353 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16354 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16355 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16356 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16357 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16358 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16359 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16360 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16361 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016363req.ssl_ver : integer
16364req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16365 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16366 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16367 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16368 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16369 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16370 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16371 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016372 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016373 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016375 ACL derivatives :
16376 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016377
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016378res.len : integer
16379 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16380 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16381 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16382 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16383 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16384 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16385 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16386 content inspection.
16387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016388res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16389 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016390 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16391 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16392 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16393 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016395res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16396 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16397 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16398 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16399 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016401 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016402
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016403res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16404rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16405 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16406 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16407 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16408 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16409 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16410 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16411 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016413wait_end : boolean
16414 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16415 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016416 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016417 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16418 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016419 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016420 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16421 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016423 Examples :
16424 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16425 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16426 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016428 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16429 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16430 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16431 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16432 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16433 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16434 tcp-request content reject
16435
16436
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200164377.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016438--------------------------------------
16439
16440It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16441This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16442data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16443its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16444HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16445content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16446to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16447more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16448response are indexed.
16449
16450base : string
16451 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16452 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16453 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16454 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16455 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16456 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16457 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16458 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16459
16460 ACL derivatives :
16461 base : exact string match
16462 base_beg : prefix match
16463 base_dir : subdir match
16464 base_dom : domain match
16465 base_end : suffix match
16466 base_len : length match
16467 base_reg : regex match
16468 base_sub : substring match
16469
16470base32 : integer
16471 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16472 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16473 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016474 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16475 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16476 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016477
16478base32+src : binary
16479 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16480 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16481 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16482 per-URL counters.
16483
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016484capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16485 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16486 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16487 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16488
16489capture.req.method : string
16490 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16491 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16492 because it's allocated.
16493
16494capture.req.uri : string
16495 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16496 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16497 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16498 allocated.
16499
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016500capture.req.ver : string
16501 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16502 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16503 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16504
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016505capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16506 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16507 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16508 The first entry is an index of 0.
16509 See also: "capture response header"
16510
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016511capture.res.ver : string
16512 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16513 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16514 persistent flag.
16515
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016516req.body : binary
16517 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16518 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16519 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16520 the first chunk is analyzed.
16521
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016522req.body_param([<name>) : string
16523 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16524 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16525 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16526 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16527 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16528 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16529 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16530 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16531 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16532 given.
16533
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016534req.body_len : integer
16535 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16536 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16537 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16538 "option http-buffer-request".
16539
16540req.body_size : integer
16541 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16542 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16543 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16544 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16545 "option http-buffer-request".
16546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016547req.cook([<name>]) : string
16548cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16549 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16550 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16551 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16552 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16553 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16554 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16555 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16556 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16557
16558 ACL derivatives :
16559 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16560 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16561 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16562 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16563 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16564 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16565 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16566 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016568req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16569cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16570 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16571 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016573req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16574cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16575 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16576 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16577 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16578 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016580cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16581 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16582 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16583 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16584 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016585 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016586 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16587 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16588 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16589 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016591hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16592 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16593 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16594 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16595 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016596 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016598req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16599 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16600 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16601 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16602 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16603 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16604 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16605 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16606 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016608req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16609 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16610 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16611 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16612 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016614req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16615 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16616 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16617 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16618 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16619 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16620 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16621 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16622 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016623 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016624 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016625 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016627 ACL derivatives :
16628 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16629 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16630 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16631 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16632 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16633 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16634 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16635 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16636
16637req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16638hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16639 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16640 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16641 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16642 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16643 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16644 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16645 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16646 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16647 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16648
16649req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16650hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16651 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16652 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16653 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16654 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16655 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016656 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016657 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16658 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16659
16660req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16661hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16662 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16663 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16664 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16665 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16666 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16667 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16668 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16669
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016670
16671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016672http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16673 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16674 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16675 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16676 basic auth is supported.
16677
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016678http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16679 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16680 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16681 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16682 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016683 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16684 basic auth is supported.
16685
16686 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016687 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16688 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16689 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16690 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016691
16692http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016693 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16694 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016695 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16696 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016698method : integer + string
16699 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16700 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16701 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16702 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16703 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16704 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16705 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016707 ACL derivatives :
16708 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016710 Example :
16711 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16712 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16713 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016715path : string
16716 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16717 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16718 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16719 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16720 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016721 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016722 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016724 ACL derivatives :
16725 path : exact string match
16726 path_beg : prefix match
16727 path_dir : subdir match
16728 path_dom : domain match
16729 path_end : suffix match
16730 path_len : length match
16731 path_reg : regex match
16732 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016733
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016734query : string
16735 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16736 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16737 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16738 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016739 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016740 which stops before the question mark.
16741
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016742req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16743 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16744 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16745 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16746 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016748req.ver : string
16749req_ver : string (deprecated)
16750 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16751 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16752 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016754 ACL derivatives :
16755 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016757res.comp : boolean
16758 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16759 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16760 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016762res.comp_algo : string
16763 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16764 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16765 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016767res.cook([<name>]) : string
16768scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16769 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16770 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16771 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016773 ACL derivatives :
16774 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016776res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16777scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16778 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16779 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16780 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016782res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16783scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16784 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16785 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16786 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016788res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16789 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16790 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16791 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16792 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16793 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16794 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16795 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16796 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16797 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016799res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16800 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16801 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16802 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16803 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16804 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016806res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16807shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16808 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16809 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16810 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16811 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16812 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16813 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16814 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16815 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016817 ACL derivatives :
16818 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16819 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16820 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16821 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16822 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16823 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16824 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16825 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16826
16827res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16828shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16829 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16830 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16831 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16832 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16833 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016835res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16836shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16837 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16838 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16839 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16840 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16841 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16842 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016843
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016844res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16845 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16846 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16847 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16848 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016850res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16851shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16852 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16853 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16854 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16855 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16856 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16857 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016859res.ver : string
16860resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16861 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16862 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016864 ACL derivatives :
16865 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016867set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16868 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16869 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016870 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016871 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016873 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16874 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016876status : integer
16877 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16878 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16879 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016880
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016881unique-id : string
16882 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16883 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16884 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16885 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16886 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16887 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016889url : string
16890 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16891 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16892 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16893 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16894 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16895 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16896 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016898 ACL derivatives :
16899 url : exact string match
16900 url_beg : prefix match
16901 url_dir : subdir match
16902 url_dom : domain match
16903 url_end : suffix match
16904 url_len : length match
16905 url_reg : regex match
16906 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016908url_ip : ip
16909 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16910 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16911 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16912 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16913 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16914 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16915 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016917url_port : integer
16918 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16919 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16920 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16921 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016922
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016923urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16924url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016925 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16926 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016927 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16928 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16929 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16930 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016931 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16932 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016933 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16934 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016936 ACL derivatives :
16937 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16938 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16939 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16940 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16941 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16942 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16943 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16944 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016945
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016947 Example :
16948 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16949 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16950 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16951 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016952
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016953urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016954 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16955 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16956 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016957
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016958url32 : integer
16959 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16960 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16961 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16962 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16963 is an unsigned integer.
16964
16965url32+src : binary
16966 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16967 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16968 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16969
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200169717.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016972---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016973
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016974Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16975every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016976order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016977
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016978ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16979---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016980FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016981HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016982HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16983HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016984HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16985HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16986HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16987HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16988LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016989METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016990METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016991METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16992METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16993METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16994METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016995METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016996METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016997RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016998REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016999TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017000WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17001---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017002
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170048. Logging
17005----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017006
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017007One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17008provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17009very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17010provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17011state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017012to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017013headers.
17014
17015In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17016about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17017send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17018
17019 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17020 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17021 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17022 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17023 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017024 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017025 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017026
17027The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17028allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17029as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17030while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17031real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17032delay.
17033
17034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170358.1. Log levels
17036---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017037
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017038TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017039source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017040HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17041in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17042track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17043syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17044about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017045
17046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170478.2. Log formats
17048----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017049
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017050HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017051and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17052slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17053options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017054
17055 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17056 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17057 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17058 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17059 extents.
17060
17061 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17062 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17063 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17064 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17065 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17066
17067 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17068 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17069 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17070 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17071 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17072
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017073 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17074 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17075 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17076 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17077
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017078 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17079
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017080Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17081specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17082field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17083servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17084always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17085identifier.
17086
17087Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17088 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17089 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17090 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17091 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17092
17093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170948.2.1. Default log format
17095-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017096
17097This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17098as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17099format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17100
17101 Example :
17102 listen www
17103 mode http
17104 log global
17105 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17106
17107 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17108 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17109 (www/HTTP)
17110
17111 Field Format Extract from the example above
17112 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17113 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17114 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17115 4 'to' to
17116 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17117 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17118
17119Detailed fields description :
17120 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17121 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17122 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17123 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17124 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17125 and processed the connection.
17126 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17127
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017128In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17129"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17130connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17131
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017132It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17133will eventually disappear.
17134
17135
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171368.2.2. TCP log format
17137---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017138
17139The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17140is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17141information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17142counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17143emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17144environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17145the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17146sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017147specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17148not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17149fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17150marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017151
17152 Example :
17153 frontend fnt
17154 mode tcp
17155 option tcplog
17156 log global
17157 default_backend bck
17158
17159 backend bck
17160 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17161
17162 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17163 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17164 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17165
17166 Field Format Extract from the example above
17167 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17168 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17169 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17170 4 frontend_name fnt
17171 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17172 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17173 7 bytes_read* 212
17174 8 termination_state --
17175 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17176 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17177
17178Detailed fields description :
17179 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017180 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17181 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17182 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017183 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017184 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017185 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017186
17187 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017188 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17189 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17190 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017191
17192 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17193 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17194 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017195 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17196 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17197 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17198 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017199
17200 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17201 and processed the connection.
17202
17203 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17204 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17205 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17206 applications.
17207
17208 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17209 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17210 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17211 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17212 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17213
17214 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17215 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17216 See "Timers" below for more details.
17217
17218 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17219 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17220 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17221 "Timers" below for more details.
17222
17223 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017224 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017225 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17226 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17227 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17228 details.
17229
17230 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17231 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17232 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17233 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17234 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17235
17236 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17237 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17238 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17239 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17240 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17241 for more details.
17242
17243 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017244 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017245 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17246 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17247 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017248 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017249
17250 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17251 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17252 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17253 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17254 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17255 caused by a denial of service attack.
17256
17257 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17258 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17259 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17260 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17261 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17262 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17263 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17264 denial of service attack.
17265
17266 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17267 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17268 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17269 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17270 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17271 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17272 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17273 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17274 be processed than on other servers.
17275
17276 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17277 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17278 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17279 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17280 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17281 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17282 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17283 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17284 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17285 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17286 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17287 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17288 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17289
17290 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17291 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17292 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17293 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17294 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17295 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017296 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017297 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17298
17299 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17300 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17301 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17302 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17303 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17304 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017305 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017306 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17307 occurs.
17308
17309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173108.2.3. HTTP log format
17311----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017312
17313The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17314is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17315the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17316are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17317emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17318generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17319"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17320which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017321frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17322is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017323
17324Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17325slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17326with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17327
17328 Example :
17329 frontend http-in
17330 mode http
17331 option httplog
17332 log global
17333 default_backend bck
17334
17335 backend static
17336 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17337
17338 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17339 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17340 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017341 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017342
17343 Field Format Extract from the example above
17344 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17345 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017346 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017347 4 frontend_name http-in
17348 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017349 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017350 7 status_code 200
17351 8 bytes_read* 2750
17352 9 captured_request_cookie -
17353 10 captured_response_cookie -
17354 11 termination_state ----
17355 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17356 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17357 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17358 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17359 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017360
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017361Detailed fields description :
17362 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017363 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17364 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17365 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017366 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017367 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017368 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017369
17370 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017371 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17372 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17373 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017374
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017375 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17376 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017377
17378 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17379 and processed the connection.
17380
17381 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17382 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17383 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17384
17385 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17386 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17387 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17388 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17389 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17390 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17391
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017392 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17393 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17394 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017395 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017396 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17397 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017398 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17399 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017400
17401 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17402 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017403 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017404
17405 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17406 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017407 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17408 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017409
17410 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17411 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17412 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17413 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17414 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017415 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17416 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017417
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017418 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17419 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17420 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17421 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17422 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17423 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17424 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017425 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017426
17427 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17428 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17429 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17430
17431 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17432 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017433 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017434 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17435 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17436 overflowing.
17437
17438 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17439 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17440 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17441 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17442 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17443 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17444 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17445 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17446
17447 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17448 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17449 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17450 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17451 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17452 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17453 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17454 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17455
17456 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17457 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17458 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17459 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17460 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17461 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17462 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17463
17464 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017465 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017466 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17467 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17468 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017469 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017470 system.
17471
17472 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17473 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17474 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17475 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17476 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17477 caused by a denial of service attack.
17478
17479 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17480 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17481 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17482 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17483 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17484 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17485 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17486 denial of service attack.
17487
17488 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17489 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17490 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17491 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17492 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17493 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17494 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17495 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17496 processed than on other servers.
17497
17498 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17499 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17500 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17501 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17502 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17503 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17504 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17505 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17506 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17507 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17508 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17509 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17510 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17511
17512 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17513 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17514 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17515 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17516 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17517 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017518 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017519 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17520
17521 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17522 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17523 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17524 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17525 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17526 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017527 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017528 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17529 occurs.
17530
17531 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17532 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17533 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17534 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17535 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17536 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17537 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17538 cookies" below for more details.
17539
17540 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17541 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17542 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17543 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17544 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17545 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17546 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17547 and cookies" below for more details.
17548
17549 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17550 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17551 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17552 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17553 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17554 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17555 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17556 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17557
17558
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200175598.2.4. Custom log format
17560------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017561
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017562The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017563mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017564
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017565HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017566Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17567separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17568prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17569
17570Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17571variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017572("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017573
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017574If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017575as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017576less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17577the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17578
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017579Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017580In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017581in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017582
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017583Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17584'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17585https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17586such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17587
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017588Flags are :
17589 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017590 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017591 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17592 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017593
17594 Example:
17595
17596 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17597 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17598
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017599 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17600
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017601At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17602
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017603 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17604 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017605
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017606the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017607
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017608 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17609 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17610 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017611
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017612and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17613
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017614 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17615 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017616
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017617Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17618
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017619 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017620 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017621 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17622 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17623 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017624 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17625 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17626 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017627 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017628 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17629 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017630 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017631 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17632 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017633 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017634 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017635 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017636 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017637 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017638 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017639 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017640 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17641 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17642 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17643 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17644 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017645 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017646 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17647 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017648 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017649 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17650 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017651 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17652 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17653 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017654 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017655 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17656 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017657 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017658 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17659 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17660 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017661 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017662 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017663 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17664 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17665 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17666 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017667 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017668 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017669 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017670 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017671 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017672 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017673 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17674 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17675 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017676 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017677 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17678 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017679 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017680 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17681 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017682 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017683 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017684 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017685 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017686
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017687 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017688
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017689
176908.2.5. Error log format
17691-----------------------
17692
17693When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17694protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17695By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17696"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017697will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017698logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17699
17700The format looks like this :
17701
17702 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17703 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17704 Connection error during SSL handshake
17705
17706 Field Format Extract from the example above
17707 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17708 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17709 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17710 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17711 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17712
17713These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17714failures.
17715
17716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177178.3. Advanced logging options
17718-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017719
17720Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17721just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17722options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17723for more information about their usage.
17724
17725
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177268.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17727------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017728
17729It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17730haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17731commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17732monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17733ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17734
17735 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17736 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17737 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17738 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17739
17740 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17741 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17742 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017743 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017744 such as other load-balancers.
17745
17746 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17747 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17748 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17749
17750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177518.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17752----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017753
17754The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17755what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17756or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017757"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017758just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17759log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17760after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17761is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17762with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17763with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17764
17765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177668.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17767------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017768
17769Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17770for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17771"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17772retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17773raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17774a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17775file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17776you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17777"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17778
17779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177808.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17781--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017782
17783Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17784multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17785them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17786"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17787logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17788error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17789and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17790too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17791useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17792alternative.
17793
17794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177958.4. Timing events
17796------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017797
17798Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17799reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17800the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17801frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017802mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17803addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17804
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017805Timings events in HTTP mode:
17806
17807 first request 2nd request
17808 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17809 t tr t tr ...
17810 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17811 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17812 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17813 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17814 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17815
17816Timings events in TCP mode:
17817
17818 TCP session
17819 |<----------------->|
17820 t t
17821 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17822 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17823 |<------ Tt ------->|
17824
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017825 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017826 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017827 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17828 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17829 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017830 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017831 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17832 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17833 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17834 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017835
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017836 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17837 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17838 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017839 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17840 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17841 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17842 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17843 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17844 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017845
17846 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17847 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17848 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17849 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17850 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17851 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17852 request typed by hand during a test.
17853
17854 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17855 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017856 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017857 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17858 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17859 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17860 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017861
17862 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17863 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17864 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17865 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17866 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17867
17868 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17869 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17870 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17871 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17872 connection never established.
17873
17874 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17875 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17876 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17877 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17878 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17879 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17880 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17881 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17882 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17883 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17884 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17885
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017886 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17887 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17888 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17889 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17890 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17891 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17892
17893 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17894
17895 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17896 "Ta" can never be negative.
17897
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017898 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17899 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017900 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17901 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017902 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017903
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017904 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017905
17906 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017907 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17908 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017909
17910These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17911protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17912that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017913due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17914"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17915that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017916
17917Most common cases :
17918
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017919 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17920 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17921 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17922 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17923 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17924 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17925 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17926 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17927 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17928 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17929 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017930 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017931
17932 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17933 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17934 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17935 of ms on remote networks.
17936
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017937 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17938 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17939 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017940
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017941 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17942 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17943 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17944 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17945 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17946 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17947 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17948 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17949 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017950
17951Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17952
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017953 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017954 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017955 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017956
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017957 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017958 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17959 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17960
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017961 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017962 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17963 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17964 flags.
17965
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017966 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17967 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017968 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17969 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17970 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17971 the client connection was maintained open.
17972
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017973 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017974 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017975 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017976 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17977
17978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179798.5. Session state at disconnection
17980-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017981
17982TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17983"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
179842-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17985each of which has a special meaning :
17986
17987 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17988 session to terminate :
17989
17990 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17991
17992 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17993 server explicitly refused it.
17994
17995 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17996 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17997 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17998 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017999 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018000
18001 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18002 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018003
18004 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18005 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18006 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18007 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18008 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18009
18010 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18011 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18012 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18013 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18014 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18015
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018016 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18017 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18018
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018019 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18020 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18021 backup connections when going up.
18022
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018023 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18024
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018025 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18026 send or receive data.
18027
18028 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18029 send or receive data.
18030
18031 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18032 with nothing left in the buffers.
18033
18034 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18035
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018036 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018037 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18038
18039 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18040 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18041 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18042 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18043 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18044
18045 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18046 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18047
18048 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18049 server (HTTP only).
18050
18051 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18052
18053 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18054 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18055 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18056
18057 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18058 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18059 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18060
18061 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18062
18063 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18064 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18065
18066 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18067 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18068 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18069
18070 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18071 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018072 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18073 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018074
18075 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18076 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18077 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18078 another server.
18079
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018080 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018081 server.
18082
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018083 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18084 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18085 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18086 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18087
18088 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18089 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18090 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18091 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18092
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018093 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18094 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18095 "use-server" rule).
18096
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018097 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18098
18099 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18100 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18101
18102 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18103
18104 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18105 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18106 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18107
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018108 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18109 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018110 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018111 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18112 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18113
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018114 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18115
18116 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18117 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18118
18119 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18120
18121 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18122
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018123The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18124was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018125helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18126starvation, attacks, etc...
18127
18128The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18129alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18130easier finding and understanding.
18131
18132 Flags Reason
18133
18134 -- Normal termination.
18135
18136 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18137 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18138 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18139 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18140
18141 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18142 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18143 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18144 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18145 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18146 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018147
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018148 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18149 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018150 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018151
18152 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18153 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18154 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18155
18156 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18157 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18158 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18159 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18160 the server takes too long to respond.
18161
18162 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18163 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18164 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18165 long a time to respond.
18166
18167 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18168 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18169 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18170 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018171 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18172 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018173
18174 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18175 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18176 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18177 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18178 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018179 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018180 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18181 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18182 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18183 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18184 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18185 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18186 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18187 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018188 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018189 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18190 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18191 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018192
18193 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18194 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018195 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18196 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18197 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18198 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018199
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018200 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18201 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018203 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018204 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18205 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018206 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018207 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18208 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18209
18210 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18211 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18212 503 or 504 here.
18213
18214 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18215 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18216 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18217 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18218 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18219
18220 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18221 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018222 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018223 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18224 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18225
18226 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18227 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18228 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18229 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18230 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18231 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18232 between haproxy and the server.
18233
18234 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18235 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18236 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18237 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18238 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18239 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18240 solution is to fix the application.
18241
18242 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18243 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18244 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18245 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18246 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18247 external attacks.
18248
18249 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18250 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018251 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018252 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18253 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18254
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018255 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18256 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18257 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018258 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018259 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018260
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018261 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18262 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18263 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18264 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018265 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18266 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18267 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18268 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18269 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018270
18271 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18272 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18273 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18274 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18275
18276 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18277 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18278 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18279 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18280
18281 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18282 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18283 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18284 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18285
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018286The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18287persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18288important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18289re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18290
18291 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18292
18293 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18294 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18295 set on a GET request.
18296
18297 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18298 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018299 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018300 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18301
18302 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18303 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18304 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18305
18306 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18307 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18308 already got a cookie.
18309
18310 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18311 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18312 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18313 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18314 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18315
18316 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18317 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18318 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18319
18320 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18321 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18322 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18323
18324 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18325 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18326
18327 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18328 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18329 then advertised in the response.
18330
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183328.6. Non-printable characters
18333-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018334
18335In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18336consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18337converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18338prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18339being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18340escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18341is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18342'}' when logging headers.
18343
18344Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18345issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18346containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18347
18348Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18349the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18350performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18351
18352
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183538.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18354---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018355
18356Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18357achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018358section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018359cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18360the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18361the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018362locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018363not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18364user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18365a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18366wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18367
18368 Examples :
18369 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18370 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18371
18372 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18373 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18374
18375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183768.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18377---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018378
18379Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18380proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18381the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18382server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18383
18384Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18385response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018386section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018387
18388It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018389time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18390appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018391are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18392and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18393follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18394request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18395in the logs.
18396
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018397As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18398frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18399an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18400
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018401 Example :
18402 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18403 listen proxy-out
18404 mode http
18405 option httplog
18406 option logasap
18407 log global
18408 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18409
18410 # log the name of the virtual server
18411 capture request header Host len 20
18412
18413 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18414 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18415
18416 # log the beginning of the referrer
18417 capture request header Referer len 20
18418
18419 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18420 capture response header Server len 20
18421
18422 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18423 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18424
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018425 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018426 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18427
18428 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18429 capture response header Via len 20
18430
18431 # log the URL location during a redirection
18432 capture response header Location len 20
18433
18434 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18435 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18436 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18437 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18438 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18439
18440 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18441 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18442 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18443 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018444 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018445
18446 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18447 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18448 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18449 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18450 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018451 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018452
18453
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184548.9. Examples of logs
18455---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018456
18457These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18458them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18459reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18460
18461 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18462 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18463 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18464
18465 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18466 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18467
18468 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18469 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18470 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18471
18472 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18473 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18474
18475 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18476 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18477 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18478
18479 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018480 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018481 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18482 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18483
18484 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18485 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18486 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18487
18488 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18489 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018490 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018491 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18492 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18493 to return the 502 and not the server.
18494
18495 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018496 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018497
18498 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18499 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18500 Nothing was sent to any server.
18501
18502 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18503 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18504
18505 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18506 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018507 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018508 send a 408 return code to the client.
18509
18510 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18511 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18512
18513 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18514 5 seconds ("c----").
18515
18516 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18517 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018518 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018519
18520 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018521 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018522 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18523 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18524 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18525 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18526 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018527
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018528
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200185299. Supported filters
18530--------------------
18531
18532Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18533accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18534unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18535
18536See also : "filter"
18537
185389.1. Trace
18539----------
18540
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018541filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018542
18543 Arguments:
18544 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18545 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18546
18547 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18548 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18549 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18550 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18551
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018552 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018553 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18554 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18555 amount of the parsed data.
18556
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018557 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018558
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018559This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18560callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18561information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18562filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18563
18564Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18565tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18566a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18567
18568
185699.2. HTTP compression
18570---------------------
18571
18572filter compression
18573
18574The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18575keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018576when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18577it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18578response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18579line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18580cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18581the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018582
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018583See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018584
18585
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200185869.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18587--------------------------------------------
18588
18589filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18590
18591 Arguments :
18592
18593 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18594 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18595 parsed.
18596
18597 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18598 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18599 part must be placed in its own scope.
18600
18601The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18602external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018603streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018604exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18605also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18606
18607SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18608the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18609
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018610For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018611"doc/SPOE.txt".
18612
18613Important note:
18614 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18615 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18616
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100186179.4. Cache
18618----------
18619
18620filter cache <name>
18621
18622 Arguments :
18623
18624 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18625
18626The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18627"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018628cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018629other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18630the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18631mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18632filter other than the compression is used for the same
18633listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18634order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018635
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018636See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018637
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001863810. Cache
18639---------
18640
18641HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18642(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18643RAM.
18644
18645The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018646this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018647
18648If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18649independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18650when we try to allocate a new one.
18651
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018652The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018653
18654It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18655"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18656for more details.
18657
18658When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18659replaced by "<CACHE>".
18660
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001866110.1. Limitation
18662----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018663
18664The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18665
18666- If the response is not a 200
18667- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018668- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018669- If the response is not cacheable
18670
18671- If the request is not a GET
18672- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018673- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018674
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018675Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18676filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18677can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18678example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18679"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018680
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001868110.2. Setup
18682-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018683
18684To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18685the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18686
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001868710.2.1. Cache section
18688---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018689
18690cache <name>
18691 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18692 size of cache is mandatory.
18693
18694total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018695 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018696 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018697
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018698max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018699 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18700 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18701 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018702
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018703max-age <seconds>
18704 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18705 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18706 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18707 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18708 default.
18709
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001871010.2.2. Proxy section
18711---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018712
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018713http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018714 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18715 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18716 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18717 after this one.
18718
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018719http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018720 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18721 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18722 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18723 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18724
18725
18726Example:
18727
18728 backend bck1
18729 mode http
18730
18731 http-request cache-use foobar
18732 http-response cache-store foobar
18733 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18734
18735 cache foobar
18736 total-max-size 4
18737 max-age 240
18738
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018739/*
18740 * Local variables:
18741 * fill-column: 79
18742 * End:
18743 */